]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
* NEWS: Mention fontSet for Lucid menus.
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ** Emacs includes now support for loading image libraries on demand.
21 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
22 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
23 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
24
25 ---
26 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the following
27 languages: Brasilian, Bulgarian, Chinese (both with simplified and
28 traditional characters), French, and Italian. Type `C-u C-h t' to
29 choose one of them in case your language setup doesn't automatically
30 select the right one.
31
32 ---
33 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
34 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
35 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
36
37 ---
38 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
39
40 ---
41 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with elisp code.
42
43 ---
44 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
45 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
46 installed programs.
47
48 ---
49 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
50 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
51 place for game scores to be stored. This may be controlled by the
52 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
53 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
54 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
55 in each user's home directory.
56
57 ---
58 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
59 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
60 Emacs with Leim.
61
62 +++
63 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
64
65 The ELisp reference manual in Info format is built as part of the
66 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
67 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
68 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
69
70 ---
71 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
72 the distribution.
73
74 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
75 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
76 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
77 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
78
79 ---
80 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
81
82 ---
83 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
84
85 ---
86 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
87
88 ---
89 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
90 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
94
95 ---
96 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
97 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
98 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
99
100 ---
101 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
102
103 ---
104 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
105 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
106
107 \f
108 * Changes in Emacs 22.1
109
110 ** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
111 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
112 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
113 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
114 M-f (forward-word)
115 M-b (backward-word)
116 M-d (kill-word)
117 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
118 M-t (transpose-words)
119 M-q (fill-paragraph)
120
121 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
122
123 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
124
125 ---
126 ** Languange environment and various default coding systems are setup
127 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
128 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
129 This change may result in using the different coding systems as
130 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
131
132 +++
133 ** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
134 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
135 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
136 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
137 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
138 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
139
140 +++
141 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
142 M-o M-o requests refontification.
143
144 +++
145 ** M-g is now a prefix key. M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
146
147 +++
148 ** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
149 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
150 The default value is 1.
151
152 +++
153 ** C-u M-x goto-line now switches to the most recent previous buffer,
154 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
155
156 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
157 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
158
159 ---
160 ** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
161 display margin, when run in an xterm.
162
163 +++
164 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
165 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
166
167 +++
168 ** Control characters and escape glyphs are now shown in the new
169 escape-glyph face.
170
171 +++
172 ** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now prefixed with an escape
173 character, unless the new user variable `show-nonbreak-escape' is set
174 to nil.
175
176 ---
177 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
178 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
179 you don't want the .type-break file in your home directory or are
180 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
181
182 ---
183 ** display-battery has been replaced by display-battery-mode.
184
185 ---
186 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode, which is available when
187 `calculator-output-radix' is non-nil. In this mode a separator
188 character is used every few digits, making it easier to see byte
189 boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the variable
190 `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
191
192 +++
193 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
194
195 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
196 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
197 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
198 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
199 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior.
200
201 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs may do much
202 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
203 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
204 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
205 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
206 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
207 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
208 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
209 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
210
211 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
212 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
213 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
214 you release it).
215
216 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
217 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
218
219 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
220 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
221
222 +++
223 ** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
224
225 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
226 when visiting the file.
227
228 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
229 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
230 when saving the file.
231
232 +++
233 ** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
234 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
235 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
236 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
237 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
238 modes do.
239
240 +++
241 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
242 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
243 you about it.
244
245 +++
246 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
247
248 +++
249 ** In Outline mode, hide-body no longer hides lines at the top
250 of the file that precede the first header line.
251
252 +++
253 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
254 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
255 and `C-c C-r'.
256
257 +++
258 ** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
259 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
260
261 +++
262 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
263 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
264
265 ---
266 ** global-whitespace-mode is a new alias for whitespace-global-mode.
267
268 +++
269 ** There are now two new regular expression operators, \_< and \_>,
270 for matching the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
271 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
272 specified by the syntax table.
273 ---
274 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
275
276 +++
277 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
278 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
279 existing values. For example:
280
281 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
282
283 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
284 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
285
286 ---
287 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved, it can
288 run most curses applications now.
289
290 ** New features in evaluation commands
291
292 +++
293 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
294 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
295
296 +++
297 *** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
298 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
299 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
300 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
301 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
302
303 ---
304 ** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
305 characters.
306
307 +++
308 ** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
309 in the current input method to input a character at point.
310
311 +++
312 ** Convenient commands to switch buffers in a cyclic order are C-x <left>
313 (prev-buffer) and C-x <right> (next-buffer).
314
315 ---
316 ** Commands winner-redo and winner-undo, from winner.el, are now bound to
317 C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an incompatible change.
318
319 ---
320 ** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
321 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
322 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
323 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
324
325 ---
326 ** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
327 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
328 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
329 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
330 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
331
332 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
333 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
334
335 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
336 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
337 lines, including any prompts.
338
339 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
340 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
341 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
342 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
343 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
344 `kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
345 kill-ring, but does not delete it.
346
347 +++
348 ** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
349 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
350
351 +++
352 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
353
354 +++
355 ** New command line option -Q or --bare-bones.
356
357 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
358 the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, the blinking
359 cursor, and the fancy startup screen.
360
361 +++
362 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
363 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
364
365 +++
366 ** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
367 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
368
369 ---
370 ** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
371 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
372 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
373
374 +++
375 ** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
376 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
377 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
378 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
379 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
380 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
381 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior may
382 be mode dependent.
383
384 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
385 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
386 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
387 toggles this mode.
388
389 +++
390 ** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
391 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
392 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
393 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
394 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
395 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
396 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
397 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
398 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
399
400 +++
401 ** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
402 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
403 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
404 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
405 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
406
407 +++
408 ** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
409 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
410 mode.
411
412 ---
413 ** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
414
415 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
416 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
417 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
418 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
419
420 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
421 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
422 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
423
424 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
425 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
426 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
427 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
428 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
429
430 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
431
432 ** Compilation mode enhancements:
433
434 +++
435 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
436 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
437 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
438 subprocesses inherit.
439
440 +++
441 ** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
442
443 ---
444 *** There's a new separate package grep.el.
445
446 ---
447 *** M-x grep has been adapted to new compile
448
449 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
450 can be saved and automatically revisited with the new Grep mode.
451
452 ---
453 *** Grep commands now have their own submenu and customization group.
454
455 +++
456 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
457 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
458
459 ---
460 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
461 `grep-scroll-output' can be used to override the corresponding
462 compilation mode settings for grep commands.
463
464 +++
465 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
466 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
467 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
468 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
469 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
470 source line is highlighted.
471
472 +++
473 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
474 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
475 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
476 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
477 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
478 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
479 file.
480
481 +++
482 ** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
483 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
484 in new face `next-error'.
485
486 +++
487 ** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
488 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
489 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
490 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
491 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
492 C-c C-f.
493
494 +++
495 ** M-x diff uses diff-mode instead of compilation-mode.
496
497 +++
498 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
499 resync points in both windows.
500
501 ---
502 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
503 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
504 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
505 using strokes as an input method.
506
507 ** Gnus package
508
509 ---
510 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
511 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
512 PGP/MIME.
513
514 ---
515 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
516 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
517
518 +++
519 ** Desktop package
520
521 +++
522 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, desktop-save-mode. Variable
523 desktop-enable is obsolete. Customize desktop-save-mode to enable desktop
524 saving.
525
526 ---
527 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
528 buffer list.
529
530 +++
531 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers immediately,
532 remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
533
534 +++
535 *** New commands:
536 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
537 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
538 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
539 it was loaded.
540 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
541 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
542
543 ---
544 *** New customizable variables:
545 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
546 killed.
547 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
548 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
549 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
550 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
551 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
552 should not delete.
553 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
554 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
555 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
556 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
557
558 +++
559 *** New command line option --no-desktop
560
561 ---
562 *** New hooks:
563 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
564 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
565
566 ---
567 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
568 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
569 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
570 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
571 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
572 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
573 feature.
574
575 +++
576 ** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
577
578 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
579 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
580 % emacsclient -s foo file1
581 % emacsclient -s bar file2
582
583 +++
584 ** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
585 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
586 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
587 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
588 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
589
590 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' may be set to nil to
591 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
592
593 +++
594 ** The buffer boundaries (i.e. first and last line in the buffer) may
595 now be marked with angle bitmaps in the fringes. In addition, up and
596 down arrow bitmaps may be shown at the top and bottom of the left or
597 right fringe if the window can be scrolled in either direction.
598
599 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
600 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
601 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
602
603 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
604 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
605
606 Value may also be an alist which specifies the presense and position
607 of each bitmap individually.
608
609 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
610 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
611 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
612 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
613
614 +++
615 ** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
616 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
617 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
618 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
619 keyboard oriented alternative.
620
621 +++
622 ** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
623 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
624 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
625 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
626 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
627
628 ---
629 ** New commands `scan-buf-next-region' and `scan-buf-previous-region'
630 move to the start of the next (previous, respectively) region with
631 non-nil help-echo property and display any help found there in the
632 echo area, using `display-local-help'.
633
634 +++
635 ** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
636 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
637 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
638 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
639 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
640 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
641 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
642
643 +++
644 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
645 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
646
647 +++
648 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
649 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
650 an interactively callable function.
651
652 ---
653 ** sql changes.
654
655 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
656 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
657 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
658 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
659 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
660
661 The following values are supported:
662
663 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
664 db2 DB2
665 informix Informix
666 ingres Ingres
667 interbase Interbase
668 linter Linter
669 ms Microsoft
670 mysql MySQL
671 oracle Oracle
672 postgres Postgres
673 solid Solid
674 sqlite SQLite
675 sybase Sybase
676
677 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
678 SQL mode indicator.
679
680 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
681 your .emacs will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
682 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
683
684 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
685
686 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
687 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
688 all identifiers ending in "_t" under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
689 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
690
691 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
692 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
693
694 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i. Most
695 SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
696 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
697
698 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
699 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
700 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
701 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
702 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
703 terminated.
704
705 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
706 called with the -E command line argument to use the operating system
707 credentials to authenticate the user.
708
709 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
710 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
711 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
712
713 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
714 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
715
716 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
717 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
718 defaults.
719
720 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
721 appropriate sql-interactive-mode wrapper for the current setting of
722 `sql-product'.
723
724 ---
725 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
726 with special modes such as Tar mode.
727
728 ** Enhancements to apropos commands:
729
730 +++
731 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
732 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
733 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
734 available.
735
736 +++
737 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
738 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
739 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
740 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
741 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
742 matching item.
743
744 +++
745 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
746 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
747 the operating system or your X server.
748
749 ---
750 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
751 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
752 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
753
754 ---
755 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
756 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
757
758 ---
759 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
760 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
761
762 +++
763 ** A prefix argument of C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-printifies the
764 list starting after point.
765
766 ** Dired mode:
767
768 ---
769 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
770 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
771 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
772
773 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
774 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
775
776 +++
777 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
778 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
779
780 +++
781 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
782 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
783 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
784 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
785 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
786 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
787
788 +++
789 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
790 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
791
792 +++
793 ** Dired-x:
794
795 +++
796 *** Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode. The mode toggling
797 command is bound to M-o. A new command dired-mark-omitted, bound to M-O,
798 marks omitted files. The variable dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the
799 mode toggling function instead.
800
801 +++
802 ** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
803 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
804
805 +++
806 ** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
807 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
808
809 ** FFAP
810
811 +++
812 *** New ffap commands and keybindings: C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
813 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
814 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
815 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
816
817 ---
818 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default. C-x C-f passes
819 it to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS argument, which visits
820 multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
821
822 ** Info mode:
823
824 +++
825 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
826 with the number appended to the *info* buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
827
828 ---
829 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
830 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
831 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
832 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
833 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
834 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
835 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
836 Info node.
837
838 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
839 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
840 search without prompting for a new search string.
841
842 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
843 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
844 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
845
846 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
847
848 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
849 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
850
851 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
852 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
853 possible matches.
854
855 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
856 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
857 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
858
859 ---
860 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
861 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
862
863 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
864 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
865
866 +++
867 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
868 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
869 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
870
871 ---
872 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
873 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
874 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
875 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
876
877 +++
878 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
879
880 ---
881 *** Info-index offers completion.
882
883 ---
884 ** Support for the SQLite interpreter has been added to sql.el by calling
885 'sql-sqlite'.
886
887 ** BibTeX mode:
888 *** The new command bibtex-url browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
889 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
890
891 *** The new command bibtex-entry-update (bound to C-c C-u) updates
892 an existing BibTeX entry.
893
894 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
895
896 *** bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries can take values `plain',
897 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
898 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
899 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
900 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
901 bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries is non-nil.
902
903 *** If the new variable bibtex-parse-keys-fast is non-nil,
904 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
905
906 *** If the new variable bibtex-autoadd-commas is non-nil,
907 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
908
909 *** The new variable bibtex-autofill-types contains a list of entry
910 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
911
912 *** The new command bibtex-complete completes word fragment before
913 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
914
915 *** The new commands bibtex-find-entry and bibtex-find-crossref
916 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
917 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
918
919 *** In BibTeX mode the command fill-paragraph (bound to M-q) fills
920 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
921
922 *** The new variables bibtex-files and bibtex-file-path define a set
923 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
924
925 *** The new command bibtex-validate-globally checks for duplicate keys
926 in multiple BibTeX files.
927
928 *** The new command bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill pushes summary
929 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
930
931 +++
932 ** When display margins are present in a window, the fringes are now
933 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
934 at the edges of the window.
935
936 +++
937 ** A window may now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
938 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
939
940 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
941 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
942 or when the frame is resized.
943
944 +++
945 ** New functions frame-current-scroll-bars and window-current-scroll-bars.
946
947 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
948 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
949
950 +++
951 ** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
952 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
953 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
954
955 +++
956 ** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
957
958 +++
959 ** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which may
960 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
961
962 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
963 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
964
965 +++
966 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
967
968 ---
969 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
970 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
971
972 +++
973 ** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
974 Emacs prompts her for confirmation.
975
976 ---
977 ** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
978
979 ---
980 ** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
981 and other common debugger commands.
982
983 ---
984 ** recentf changes.
985
986 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
987 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
988 automatic cleanup.
989
990 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
991 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
992 keep in the recent list.
993
994 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
995 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
996 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
997 recent list with different symbolic links.
998
999 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
1000 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
1001 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
1002
1003 +++
1004 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
1005 from the locale.
1006
1007 +++
1008 ** Init file changes
1009
1010 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
1011 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
1012
1013 ---
1014 ** partial-completion-mode now does partial completion on directory names.
1015
1016 ---
1017 ** skeleton.el now supports using - to mark the skeleton-point without
1018 interregion interaction. @ has reverted to only setting
1019 skeleton-positions and no longer sets skeleton-point. Skeletons
1020 which used @ to mark skeleton-point independent of _ should now use -
1021 instead. The updated skeleton-insert docstring explains these new
1022 features along with other details of skeleton construction.
1023
1024 ---
1025 ** MH-E changes.
1026
1027 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.82. There have been major changes since
1028 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
1029
1030 +++
1031 ** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
1032 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given elisp
1033 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
1034
1035 +++
1036 ** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
1037
1038 +++
1039 ** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
1040 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
1041 appears between the position information and the major mode.
1042
1043 +++
1044 ** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
1045 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
1046
1047 +++
1048 ** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
1049 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
1050 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
1051 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
1052 set-fringe-style.
1053
1054 +++
1055 ** There is a new user option `mail-default-directory' that allows you
1056 to specify the value of `default-directory' for mail buffers. This
1057 directory is used for auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to
1058 "~/".
1059
1060 +++
1061 ** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
1062 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
1063 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
1064 file.)
1065
1066 +++
1067 ** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1068 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1069
1070 +++
1071 ** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1072 of a file.
1073
1074 ---
1075 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
1076
1077 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
1078 ps-print, provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF fonts.
1079 See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
1080
1081 ---
1082 ** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1083 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1084 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1085
1086 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1087 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1088 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1089 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1090 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1091
1092 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1093 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1094 t, and the status is shown.
1095
1096 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1097 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1098
1099 +++
1100 ** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1101 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1102 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1103 faces.
1104
1105 ---
1106 ** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1107 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1108 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1109 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1110 automatically according to the locale.)
1111
1112 ---
1113 ** Indian support has been updated.
1114 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1115 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1116 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1117 supported.
1118
1119 ---
1120 ** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1121 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1122 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1123 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1124 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1125 tamil-inscript.
1126
1127 ---
1128 ** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1129 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1130 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1131
1132 ---
1133 ** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
1134 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
1135 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
1136 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
1137 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
1138 latter is used by GNU locales.
1139
1140 ---
1141 ** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1142 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1143 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1144 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1145 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1146 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1147 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1148 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1149 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1150 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1151 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1152 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1153
1154 ---
1155 ** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1156 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1157
1158 ---
1159 ** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1160 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1161 fontset appropriately.
1162
1163 ---
1164 ** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1165 unicode.
1166
1167 +++
1168 ** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1169 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1170 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1171 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1172 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1173 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1174 mule-unicode-... ones.
1175
1176 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1177 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1178 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1179 possible.
1180
1181 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1182 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1183 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1184 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1185 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1186
1187 ---
1188 ** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1189 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1190 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1191 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1192
1193 +++
1194 ** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1195 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1196 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1197 command.
1198
1199 ---
1200 ** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1201 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1202 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1203
1204 ---
1205 ** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
1206 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
1207
1208 +++
1209 ** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
1210 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
1211 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
1212
1213 ---
1214 ** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
1215 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
1216
1217 ---
1218 ** Dialogs and menus pop down when pressing C-g.
1219
1220 ---
1221 ** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
1222 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
1223 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
1224
1225 +++
1226 ** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
1227 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
1228
1229 +++
1230 ** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
1231 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
1232 the new dialog.
1233
1234 +++
1235 ** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
1236 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
1237 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
1238 cursor does.
1239
1240 +++
1241 ** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
1242 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
1243
1244 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1245 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1246 program files that include other program files.
1247
1248 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1249 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1250 in them.
1251
1252 ---
1253 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1254 when Emacs visits them.
1255
1256 ---
1257 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
1258
1259 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
1260 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
1261 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
1262
1263 ---
1264 ** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1265 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1266 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1267 and use the more appropriately result.
1268
1269 +++
1270 ** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
1271 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
1272 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
1273 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
1274
1275 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
1276 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
1277 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
1278 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
1279 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
1280 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
1281
1282 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
1283 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
1284
1285 ** TeX modes:
1286
1287 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
1288
1289 +++
1290 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
1291 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
1292 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
1293 TeX commands to use at startup.
1294
1295 ---
1296 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
1297 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
1298
1299 +++
1300 *** New major mode doctex-mode for *.dtx files.
1301
1302 +++
1303 ** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
1304 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
1305 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
1306 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
1307 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
1308 feature is not enabled.
1309
1310 +++
1311 ** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
1312 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
1313 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
1314 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
1315 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
1316 to give it focus.
1317
1318 +++
1319 ** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
1320 description various information about a character, including its
1321 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
1322 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
1323 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
1324
1325 +++
1326 ** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1327 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1328 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1329 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1330 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1331
1332 +++
1333 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
1334 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
1335 in Indented-Text mode.
1336
1337 ---
1338 ** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
1339 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
1340 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
1341
1342 +++
1343 ** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
1344 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
1345 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
1346 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
1347 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
1348 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
1349 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
1350 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
1351 can be edited for each replacement.
1352
1353 +++
1354 ** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
1355 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
1356
1357 ---
1358 ** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
1359 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
1360
1361 +++
1362 ** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
1363 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
1364 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1365 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1366 also disable mouse highlighting.
1367
1368 +++
1369 ** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1370 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1371 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1372
1373 +++
1374 ** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
1375 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
1376 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
1377 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
1378 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
1379
1380 +++
1381 ** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
1382 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
1383 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
1384 prompt string.
1385
1386 +++
1387 ** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
1388 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
1389 the mode line of the currently selected window.
1390
1391 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
1392 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
1393
1394 ---
1395 ** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
1396 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
1397 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
1398 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
1399 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
1400 current date and time, current line and column number in the
1401 mode-line.
1402
1403 ---
1404 ** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
1405
1406 +++
1407 ** Emacs can now indicate in the mode-line the presence of new e-mail
1408 in a directory or in a file. See the documentation of the user option
1409 `display-time-mail-directory'.
1410
1411 ---
1412 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
1413
1414 +++
1415 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
1416 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
1417 argument it toggles the mode.
1418
1419 Turning off PC-Selection mode restores the global key bindings
1420 that were replaced by turning on the mode.
1421
1422 +++
1423 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
1424 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
1425 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
1426 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
1427 `inhibit-splash-screen').
1428
1429 ** Changes in support of colors on character terminals
1430
1431 +++
1432 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1433 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1434 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1435 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1436 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1437 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1438 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1439 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1440 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1441
1442 ---
1443 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1444 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1445 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1446 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1447 all of these colors.
1448
1449 +++
1450 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1451 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1452 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1453 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1454 colors as on X.
1455
1456 ---
1457 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1458
1459 +++
1460 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
1461
1462 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
1463 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
1464 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
1465 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
1466
1467 ---
1468 ** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
1469 automatically.
1470
1471 +++
1472 ** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1473 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1474 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1475 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1476
1477 +++
1478 ** Changes in C-h bindings:
1479
1480 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
1481
1482 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
1483 that do not change:
1484
1485 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
1486 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
1487
1488 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
1489 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
1490
1491 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
1492
1493 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
1494 run by the key sequence.
1495
1496 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
1497 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
1498 that command.
1499
1500 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
1501 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
1502
1503 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
1504 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
1505
1506 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
1507 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
1508
1509 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
1510 new-kill-line is on C-k
1511
1512 +++
1513 ** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
1514 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
1515 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
1516 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
1517 for details.
1518
1519 +++
1520 ** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
1521 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
1522 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
1523 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
1524
1525 +++
1526 ** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
1527 at the end of a line.
1528
1529 +++
1530 ** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
1531 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
1532 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
1533
1534 +++
1535 ** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
1536 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
1537 search string used as the string to replace.
1538
1539 +++
1540 ** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
1541 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
1542 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
1543
1544 +++
1545 ** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
1546 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
1547 elements are deleted.
1548
1549 +++
1550 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
1551 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
1552 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
1553 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
1554
1555 +++
1556 ** Occur, Info, and comint-derived modes now support using
1557 M-x font-lock-mode to toggle fontification. The variable
1558 `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable fontification,
1559 remove `turn-on-font-lock' from `Info-mode-hook'.
1560
1561 +++
1562 ** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1563 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1564 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1565 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1566 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1567 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1568
1569 ---
1570 ** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1571 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1572 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1573 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1574 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1575 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1576 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1577
1578 +++
1579 ** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1580 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1581 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1582 under the "[State]" button.
1583
1584 ---
1585 ** The new customization type `float' specifies numbers with floating
1586 point (no integers are allowed).
1587
1588 +++
1589 ** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
1590 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
1591
1592 ---
1593 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
1594
1595 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
1596 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
1597 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
1598 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
1599 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
1600
1601 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
1602 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
1603 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
1604 (gud-finish).
1605
1606 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
1607 (Java 1.1 jdb).
1608
1609 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
1610 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
1611 Set gud-jdb-use-classpath to nil.
1612
1613 Added Customization Variables
1614
1615 *** gud-jdb-command-name. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
1616
1617 *** gud-jdb-use-classpath. Allows selection of java source file searching
1618 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan gud-jdb-directories for
1619 java sources (previous method).
1620
1621 *** gud-jdb-directories. List of directories to scan and search for java
1622 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if gud-jdb-use-classpath
1623 is nil).
1624
1625 Minor Improvements
1626
1627 *** The STARTTLS elisp wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
1628 instead of the OpenSSL based "starttls" tool. For backwards
1629 compatibility, it prefers "starttls", but you can toggle
1630 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
1631 "starttls" tool).
1632
1633 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
1634
1635 +++
1636 ** hide-ifdef-mode now uses overlays rather than selective-display
1637 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
1638 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
1639
1640 +++
1641 ** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
1642 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
1643 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
1644 is only rarely needed.
1645
1646 ---
1647 ** JIT-lock changes
1648 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
1649
1650 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
1651 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
1652 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
1653 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
1654
1655 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
1656
1657 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
1658 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
1659 refontification takes place.
1660
1661 +++
1662 ** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times. If
1663 you hit M-C-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h (mark-paragraph), or
1664 C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region extends each time, so
1665 you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC M-C-SPC, for example.
1666 This feature also works for mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to
1667 a key. It also extends the region when the mark is active in Transient
1668 Mark mode, regardless of the last command. To start a new region with
1669 one of marking commands in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the
1670 active region with C-g, or set the new mark with C-SPC.
1671
1672 +++
1673 ** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
1674 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
1675 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
1676 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
1677 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
1678 command only.
1679
1680 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
1681 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
1682 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
1683 mark or the region.
1684
1685 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
1686 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
1687 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
1688 C-g.
1689
1690 +++
1691 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
1692 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
1693 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
1694
1695 +++
1696 ** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
1697 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
1698 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
1699
1700 +++
1701 ** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1702 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1703 switching to it.
1704
1705 +++
1706 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
1707 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
1708 affects the initial frame.
1709
1710 +++
1711 ** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
1712 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
1713 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
1714 paragraphs.
1715
1716 +++
1717 ** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1718 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1719 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1720 directory listing into a buffer.
1721
1722 ---
1723 ** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1724 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1725
1726 ---
1727 ** Unexpected yanking of text due to accidental clicking on the mouse
1728 wheel button (typically mouse-2) during wheel scrolling is now avoided.
1729 This behavior can be customized via the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1730 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1731
1732 +++
1733 ** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1734 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1735 may mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1736 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1737 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1738 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1739 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1740 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1741
1742 +++
1743 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
1744 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
1745 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
1746 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
1747 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
1748
1749 +++
1750 ** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
1751 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
1752 appears in.
1753
1754 +++
1755 ** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
1756 of the recognized cursor types.
1757
1758 ---
1759 ** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
1760 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
1761 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
1762
1763 +++
1764 ** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
1765 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
1766
1767 +++
1768 ** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
1769 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
1770 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
1771 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
1772 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
1773 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
1774 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
1775 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
1776 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
1777
1778 +++
1779 ** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
1780 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
1781 count backward from the end of the year.
1782
1783 +++
1784 ** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
1785 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
1786 day of that ISO week.
1787
1788 ---
1789 ** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
1790 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
1791
1792 ---
1793 ** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
1794 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
1795 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
1796 `christian-holidays' simpler.
1797
1798 ---
1799 ** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
1800 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
1801 and `diary-header-line-format'.
1802
1803 +++
1804 ** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed: use
1805 the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
1806 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
1807 appt-issue-message, appt-visible, and appt-msg-window.
1808
1809 +++
1810 ** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
1811 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
1812 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
1813 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
1814 formats.
1815
1816
1817 ** VC Changes
1818
1819 +++
1820 *** The key C-x C-q no longer checks files in or out, it only changes
1821 the read-only state of the buffer (toggle-read-only). We made this
1822 change because we held a poll and found that many users were unhappy
1823 with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this behavior, you
1824 can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your .emacs:
1825
1826 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
1827
1828 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
1829
1830 +++
1831 *** There is a new user option `vc-cvs-global-switches' that allows
1832 you to specify switches that are passed to any CVS command invoked
1833 by VC. These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which
1834 means they are inserted before the command name. For example, this
1835 allows you to specify a compression level using the "-z#" option for
1836 CVS.
1837
1838 +++
1839 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
1840
1841 ** EDiff changes.
1842
1843 +++
1844 *** When comparing directories.
1845 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
1846 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
1847 from one directory to another.
1848
1849 +++
1850 *** When comparing files or buffers.
1851 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
1852 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
1853 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
1854 comparison.
1855
1856 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
1857 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
1858 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
1859
1860 +++
1861 ** Etags changes.
1862
1863 *** New regular expressions features
1864
1865 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
1866 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
1867 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
1868 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
1869 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
1870 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
1871 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
1872 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
1873 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
1874 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
1875 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
1876
1877 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in Gcc.
1878 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
1879 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
1880 CR, TAB, VT,
1881
1882 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
1883 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
1884 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
1885 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
1886
1887 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
1888 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
1889 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
1890
1891 *** New language parsing features
1892
1893 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
1894 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
1895
1896 **** The gnucc __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
1897
1898 **** New language HTML.
1899 Title and h1, h2, h3 are tagged. Also, tags are generated when name= is
1900 used inside an anchor and whenever id= is used.
1901
1902 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
1903 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
1904 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
1905
1906 **** New language Lua.
1907 All functions are tagged.
1908
1909 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
1910 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
1911 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
1912 package::sub.
1913
1914 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
1915
1916 **** New language PHP.
1917 Tags are functions, classes and defines.
1918 If the --members option is specified to etags, tags are variables also.
1919
1920 **** New default keywords for TeX.
1921 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
1922 renewenvironment.
1923
1924 *** Honour #line directives.
1925 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
1926 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
1927 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
1928 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
1929 writes tags pointing to the source file.
1930
1931 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
1932 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
1933 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
1934 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
1935 the file FILE.
1936
1937 +++
1938 ** CC Mode changes.
1939
1940 *** Font lock support.
1941 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1942 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1943 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1944 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1945 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1946 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1947
1948 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1949 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1950 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1951 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1952 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1953 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1954 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1955 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1956 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1957
1958 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1959 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1960 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1961 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1962 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1963 take the better part of a minute.
1964
1965 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1966 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1967 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1968 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1969 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1970 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1971
1972 **** Support for documentation comments.
1973 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1974 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1975 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1976 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1977
1978 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1979 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1980 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1981 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1982
1983 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
1984 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1985 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1986 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1987 parens.
1988
1989 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1990 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1991 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1992 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1993 not as configurable as it ought to be.
1994
1995 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1996 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1997 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1998 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1999 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
2000
2001 *** Support for the AWK language.
2002 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
2003 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
2004 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
2005 Here is a summary:
2006
2007 **** Indentation Engine
2008 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
2009
2010 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
2011 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
2012 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
2013 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
2014 definition, or structured statement.
2015
2016 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
2017 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
2018 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
2019
2020 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
2021 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
2022 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
2023 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
2024
2025 **** Font Locking
2026 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
2027 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
2028 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
2029 the AWK language itself.
2030
2031 **** Comment Commands
2032 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
2033 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
2034
2035 **** Movement Commands
2036 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
2037 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
2038 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
2039
2040 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
2041 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
2042 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
2043 functions.
2044
2045 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2046 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
2047 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
2048 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
2049
2050 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2051 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2052 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2053 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2054 composition-close, and incomposition.
2055
2056 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2057 The functions c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forward can be
2058 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
2059 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
2060
2061 *** Better control over require-final-newline. The variable that
2062 controls how to handle a final newline when the buffer is saved,
2063 require-final-newline, is now customizable on a per-mode basis through
2064 c-require-final-newline. That is a list of modes, and only those
2065 modes set require-final-newline. By default that's C, C++ and
2066 Objective-C.
2067
2068 The specified modes set require-final-newline based on
2069 mode-require-final-newline, as usual.
2070
2071 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2072 The elements in the syntactic context returned by c-guess-basic-syntax
2073 and stored in c-syntactic-context has been changed somewhat to allow
2074 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2075 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2076
2077 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2078
2079 is now analysed as
2080
2081 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2082
2083 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2084 symbol.
2085
2086 This change might affect code that call c-guess-basic-syntax directly,
2087 and custom lineup functions if they use c-syntactic-context. However,
2088 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
2089 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
2090
2091 *** API changes for derived modes.
2092 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2093 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2094 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2095 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2096 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2097
2098 **** New language variable system.
2099 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2100
2101 **** New initialization functions.
2102 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2103 give better control: c-basic-common-init, c-font-lock-init, and
2104 c-init-language-vars.
2105
2106 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2107 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2108 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2109 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2110
2111 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2112 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2113 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2114 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2115 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2116
2117 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2118 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2119 its substatement. E.g:
2120
2121 if (x)
2122 x_is_true:
2123 do_stuff();
2124
2125 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2126
2127 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2128 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2129 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2130 variable c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros. A new syntactic symbol
2131 cpp-define-intro has been added to control the initial indentation
2132 inside #define's.
2133
2134 **** New lineup function c-lineup-cpp-define.
2135 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2136 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2137 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2138 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2139 much line c-lineup-dont-change, which was used earlier, but handles
2140 empty lines within the macro better.
2141
2142 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2143 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2144 c-context-line-break and c-context-open-line.
2145
2146 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2147 c-backslash-region tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2148 variable c-backslash-max-column which put a limit on how far out
2149 backslashes can be moved.
2150
2151 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2152 This is controlled by the new variable c-auto-align-backslashes. It
2153 affects c-context-line-break, c-context-open-line and newlines
2154 inserted in auto-newline mode.
2155
2156 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2157 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2158 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2159 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2160 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2161 backslash) in the macro.
2162
2163 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2164 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2165 the variable c-indent-comment-alist. The indentation behavior based
2166 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
2167 and #endif but indentation to comment-column in most other cases
2168 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2169
2170 *** New function c-context-open-line.
2171 It's the open-line equivalent of c-context-line-break.
2172
2173 *** New lineup functions
2174
2175 **** c-lineup-string-cont
2176 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2177 continues. E.g:
2178
2179 result = prefix + "A message "
2180 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2181
2182 **** c-lineup-cascaded-calls
2183 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2184
2185 **** c-lineup-knr-region-comment
2186 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2187 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2188
2189 **** c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg
2190 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks. Contributed by Kevin
2191 Ryde.
2192
2193 **** c-lineup-argcont
2194 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2195 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
2196
2197 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2198 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2199 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2200 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2201 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2202 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2203
2204 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2205 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2206 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2207 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2208 context.
2209
2210 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2211 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2212 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2213 happen when macros are involved.
2214
2215 *** Improved the way c-indent-exp chooses the block to indent.
2216 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2217 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2218 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2219 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2220 line is left untouched.
2221
2222 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2223 The function c-toggle-syntactic-indentation can be used to toggle
2224 syntactic indentation.
2225
2226 +++
2227 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
2228 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
2229
2230 +++
2231 ** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
2232 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
2233
2234 +++
2235 ** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
2236 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
2237 whose names begin with space are omitted.
2238
2239 +++
2240 ** You can now customize fill-nobreak-predicate to control where
2241 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
2242 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
2243
2244 We provide two sample predicates, fill-single-word-nobreak-p and
2245 fill-french-nobreak-p, for use in the value of fill-nobreak-predicate.
2246
2247 +++
2248 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
2249 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
2250 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
2251
2252 +++
2253 ** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2254 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2255 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2256 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2257 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2258 from the file name or buffer contents.
2259
2260 +++
2261 ** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2262
2263 ---
2264 ** Lisp mode now uses font-lock-doc-face for the docstrings.
2265
2266 ---
2267 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2268
2269 ---
2270 ** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2271 highlighting for the old default.
2272
2273 +++
2274 ** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2275 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2276 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2277
2278 +++
2279 ** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2280 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2281 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2282 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2283
2284 ---
2285 ** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for hs-minor-mode (hideshow).
2286 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2287 majority.
2288
2289 ---
2290 ** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2291 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2292
2293 ---
2294 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2295 to support use of font-lock.
2296
2297 +++
2298 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
2299 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
2300 `same-window'.
2301
2302 +++
2303 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variables of the form `$foo' and
2304 `${foo}' in the specified new value of the environment variable. To
2305 include a `$' in the value, use `$$'.
2306
2307 +++
2308 ** File-name completion can now ignore directories.
2309 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
2310 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
2311 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
2312 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
2313 candidate is a directory.
2314
2315 +++
2316 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
2317 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
2318 it remains unchanged.
2319
2320 ---
2321 ** Enhanced visual feedback in *Completions* buffer.
2322
2323 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
2324 have in common and where they begin to differ.
2325
2326 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
2327 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
2328 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
2329 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
2330 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
2331 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
2332 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
2333 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
2334
2335 +++
2336 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
2337 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
2338 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
2339
2340 ---
2341 ** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2342
2343 +++
2344 ** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2345 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2346 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2347 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2348 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2349 used instead of the native one.
2350
2351 ---
2352 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
2353 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
2354 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
2355
2356 ---
2357 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
2358 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
2359
2360 ---
2361 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
2362 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
2363 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
2364 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
2365 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
2366 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
2367 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
2368
2369 ---
2370 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
2371 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
2372 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
2373 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
2374 sound support for those formats.
2375
2376 ---
2377 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
2378 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
2379
2380 ---
2381 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
2382 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
2383 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
2384 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
2385
2386 ---
2387 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
2388 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
2389 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
2390 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
2391 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
2392 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
2393 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
2394 you wish to use them in other faces.
2395
2396 ---
2397 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
2398 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
2399 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
2400 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
2401 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
2402 any customizations.
2403
2404 +++
2405 ** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
2406 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
2407 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
2408 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
2409 Meta and Alt:
2410 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
2411 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
2412
2413 +++
2414 ** vc-annotate-mode enhancements
2415
2416 In vc-annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2417 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2418 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2419
2420 P: annotates the previous revision
2421 N: annotates the next revision
2422 J: annotates the revision at line
2423 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2424 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2425 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2426 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2427
2428 +++
2429 ** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2430 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2431 in the repository.
2432
2433 +++
2434 ** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2435 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2436 "checkout", "update" or "commit". That means using cvs diff options
2437 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2438
2439 ---
2440 ** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
2441 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
2442 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
2443 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
2444
2445 +++
2446 ** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
2447 coding system.
2448
2449 \f
2450 * New modes and packages in Emacs 22.1
2451
2452 +++
2453 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
2454 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
2455 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
2456 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
2457 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
2458 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
2459 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
2460 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
2461 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
2462
2463 +++
2464 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
2465 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
2466 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
2467 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
2468 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
2469 recognized.
2470
2471 +++
2472 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
2473 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
2474 to increment the SOA serial.
2475
2476 +++
2477 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
2478 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
2479
2480 ** The library tree-widget.el provides a new widget to display a set
2481 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
2482 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
2483
2484 +++
2485 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
2486 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
2487
2488 +++
2489 ** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
2490 and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
2491
2492 +++
2493 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
2494
2495 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
2496
2497 +++
2498 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
2499 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
2500
2501 ---
2502 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
2503
2504 ---
2505 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2506
2507 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
2508 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
2509 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
2510 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
2511
2512 ---
2513 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2514
2515 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
2516 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
2517 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
2518 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
2519 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
2520 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
2521
2522 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
2523 rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
2524 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
2525 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
2526
2527 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
2528 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
2529 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
2530 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
2531 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
2532 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
2533 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
2534
2535 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
2536 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
2537 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
2538
2539 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
2540 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
2541
2542 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
2543 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
2544 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
2545 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
2546
2547 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
2548 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
2549 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you may customize the
2550 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
2551
2552 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
2553 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
2554 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
2555 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
2556
2557 +++
2558 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
2559 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
2560 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
2561 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
2562 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
2563
2564 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
2565 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
2566 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
2567 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
2568 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
2569 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
2570
2571 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
2572 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
2573 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
2574 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
2575 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
2576 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
2577 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
2578 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
2579 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
2580 or local keymaps.
2581
2582 +++
2583 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
2584 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
2585
2586 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
2587 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
2588 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
2589 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
2590
2591 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
2592 defined macros.
2593
2594 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
2595 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
2596 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
2597 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
2598 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
2599 for more commands.
2600
2601 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
2602 the keyboard macro ring.
2603
2604 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
2605 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
2606
2607 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
2608 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
2609 this behavior via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
2610 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
2611
2612 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
2613 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
2614 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
2615
2616 ---
2617 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2618 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2619 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2620 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2621
2622 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2623
2624 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
2625 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
2626 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
2627 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
2628 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
2629 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
2630
2631 +++
2632 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2633
2634 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
2635 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
2636 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
2637 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
2638
2639 +++
2640 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
2641
2642 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
2643 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
2644 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
2645 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
2646 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
2647 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
2648 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
2649 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
2650 `rsync' to do the copying).
2651
2652 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
2653 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
2654
2655 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
2656
2657 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
2658
2659 ---
2660 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
2661 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
2662 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
2663 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
2664 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method may
2665 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
2666
2667 ---
2668 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
2669 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
2670 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
2671 settings.
2672
2673 ---
2674 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
2675 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
2676 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
2677 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
2678
2679 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
2680
2681 ---
2682 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
2683 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
2684
2685 +++
2686 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
2687 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
2688 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
2689 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
2690 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
2691 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
2692
2693 +++
2694 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
2695 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
2696 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
2697 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
2698
2699 ---
2700 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
2701 Emacs will still work on terminals that require magic cookies in order
2702 to use standout mode, however they will not be able to display
2703 mode-lines in inverse-video.
2704
2705 ---
2706 ** cplus-md.el has been removed to avoid problems with Custom.
2707
2708 +++
2709 ** New package benchmark.el contains simple support for convenient
2710 timing measurements of code (including the garbage collection component).
2711
2712 ---
2713 ** The new Lisp library fringe.el controls the appearance of fringes.
2714
2715 ---
2716 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
2717 configuration files.
2718 \f
2719 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
2720
2721 +++
2722 ** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
2723 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
2724 it returns just the directory name.
2725
2726 +++
2727 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
2728 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
2729 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
2730 `undefined'.)
2731
2732 +++
2733 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
2734 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
2735 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
2736 \f
2737 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
2738
2739 ---
2740 ** easy-mmode-define-global-mode has been renamed to
2741 define-global-minor-mode. The old name remains as an alias.
2742
2743 +++
2744 ** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
2745 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
2746 the filtered substring. It is used instead of `buffer-substring' or
2747 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
2748 data structure, like the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register. The
2749 list of filter function is specified by the new variable
2750 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode uses
2751 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
2752 text.
2753
2754 +++
2755 ** An element of buffer-undo-list can now have the form (apply FUNNAME
2756 . ARGS), where FUNNAME is a symbol other than t or nil. That stands
2757 for a high-level change that should be undone by evaluating (apply
2758 FUNNAME ARGS).
2759
2760 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
2761 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
2762 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
2763
2764 +++
2765 ** The line-move, scroll-up, and scroll-down functions will now
2766 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
2767 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presense of
2768 large images. To disable this feature, Lisp code may bind the new
2769 variable `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
2770
2771 +++
2772 ** If a buffer sets buffer-save-without-query to non-nil,
2773 save-some-buffers will always save that buffer without asking
2774 (if it's modified).
2775
2776 +++
2777 ** The function symbol-file tells you which file defined
2778 a certain function or variable.
2779
2780 +++
2781 ** Lisp code can now test if a given buffer position is inside a
2782 clickable link with the new function `mouse-on-link-p'. This is the
2783 function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link' functionality.
2784
2785 +++
2786 ** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
2787 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
2788 quit had occurred. while-no-input returns the value of BODY, if BODY
2789 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
2790
2791 +++
2792 ** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
2793 precedence over the file name. Likewise an <?xml or <!DOCTYPE declaration
2794 will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new var
2795 `magic-mode-alist'.
2796
2797 +++
2798 ** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
2799 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
2800 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
2801
2802 +++
2803 ** New functions `make-progress-reporter', `progress-reporter-update',
2804 `progress-reporter-force-update', `progress-reporter-done', and
2805 `dotimes-with-progress-reporter' provide a simple and efficient way for
2806 a command to present progress messages for the user.
2807
2808 ---
2809 ** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
2810 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
2811 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
2812 several versions ago.
2813
2814 +++
2815 ** read-from-minibuffer now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
2816 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
2817
2818 +++
2819 ** The new variable search-spaces-regexp controls how to search
2820 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
2821 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
2822 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
2823
2824 Spaces inside of constructs such as [..] and *, +, ? are never
2825 replaced with search-spaces-regexp.
2826
2827 ---
2828 ** list-buffers-noselect now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
2829 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
2830
2831 ---
2832 ** set-buffer-file-coding-system now takes an additional argument,
2833 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
2834
2835 +++
2836 ** The new function syntax-after returns the syntax code
2837 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
2838 of text properties as well as the character code.
2839
2840 +++
2841 ** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
2842 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
2843
2844 +++
2845 ** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
2846 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' did: it returns t if the
2847 calling function was called through `call-interactively'. This should
2848 only be used when you cannot add a new "interactive" argument to the
2849 command.
2850
2851 +++
2852 ** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
2853 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
2854 been declared obsolete.
2855
2856 +++
2857 ** An interactive specification may now use the code letter 'U' to get
2858 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
2859 previous 'k' or 'K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
2860
2861 +++
2862 ** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
2863 argument.
2864
2865 +++
2866 ** Major mode functions now run the new normal hook
2867 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode hooks.
2868
2869 +++
2870 ** `auto-save-file-format' has been renamed to
2871 `buffer-auto-save-file-format' and made into a permanent local.
2872
2873 +++
2874 ** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
2875 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
2876 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
2877
2878 +++
2879 ** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
2880 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
2881 the usable window height and width is used.
2882
2883 +++
2884 ** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
2885 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
2886
2887 +++
2888 ** If a command sets transient-mark-mode to `only', that
2889 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
2890 During that following command, the value of transient-mark-mode
2891 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
2892 it changes to nil.
2893
2894 +++
2895 ** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
2896
2897 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
2898 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
2899 example,
2900
2901 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
2902
2903 +++
2904 ** The sentinel is now called when a network process is deleted with
2905 delete-process. The status message passed to the sentinel for a
2906 deleted network process is "deleted". The message passed to the
2907 sentinel when the connection is closed by the remote peer has been
2908 changed to "connection broken by remote peer".
2909
2910 +++
2911 ** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
2912 undo-outer-limit, garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
2913 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
2914
2915 ---
2916 ** New function quail-find-key returns a list of keys to type in the
2917 current input method to input a character.
2918
2919 +++
2920 ** New functions posn-at-point and posn-at-x-y return
2921 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
2922 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
2923
2924 +++
2925 ** skip-chars-forward and skip-chars-backward now handle
2926 character classes such as [:alpha:], along with individual characters
2927 and ranges.
2928
2929 +++
2930 ** Function pos-visible-in-window-p now returns the pixel coordinates
2931 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
2932 arg is non-nil.
2933
2934 +++
2935 ** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
2936
2937 +++
2938 ** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
2939 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
2940 operation.
2941
2942 +++
2943 ** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
2944 supported on text terminals.
2945
2946 +++
2947 ** Support for displaying image slices
2948
2949 *** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) may be used with
2950 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
2951
2952 *** Function insert-image has new optional fourth arg to
2953 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
2954
2955 *** New function insert-sliced-image inserts a given image as a
2956 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
2957
2958 +++
2959 ** New line-height and line-spacing properties for newline characters
2960
2961 A newline may now have line-height and line-spacing text or overlay
2962 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
2963
2964 If the line-height property value is t, the newline does not
2965 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
2966 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a line-spacing property on this
2967 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
2968 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
2969
2970 If the line-height property value is a positive integer, the value
2971 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
2972 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
2973
2974 If the line-height property value is a float, the minimum line height
2975 is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by the
2976 given value.
2977
2978 If the line-height property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
2979 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
2980 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
2981
2982 If the line-height property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
2983 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
2984
2985 If the line-height value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
2986 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
2987 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
2988 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
2989 exactly that many pixels high.
2990
2991 If the line-spacing property value is an positive integer, the value
2992 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
2993 overrides the default frame line-spacing and any buffer local value of
2994 the line-spacing variable.
2995
2996 If the line-spacing property may be a float or cons, the line spacing
2997 is calculated as specified above for the line-height property.
2998
2999 +++
3000 ** The buffer local line-spacing variable may now have a float value,
3001 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
3002
3003 +++
3004 ** Enhancements to stretch display properties
3005
3006 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
3007 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
3008 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
3009
3010 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
3011 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
3012 are supported:
3013
3014 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
3015 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
3016 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
3017 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
3018 | scroll-bar | text
3019 POS ::= left | center | right
3020 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
3021 OP ::= + | -
3022
3023 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
3024 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
3025 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
3026 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
3027 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
3028 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
3029 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
3030 the image.
3031
3032 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
3033 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
3034 corresponding area of the window.
3035
3036 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
3037 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
3038 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
3039 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
3040 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
3041 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
3042 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
3043 the width of the area.
3044
3045 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
3046 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
3047
3048 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
3049 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
3050 header-line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
3051
3052 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
3053 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
3054 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
3055 height) of the specified image.
3056
3057 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
3058 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
3059
3060 +++
3061 ** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
3062 text property string that may be present at the current window
3063 position. The cursor may now be placed on any character of such
3064 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
3065
3066 +++
3067 ** New macro with-local-quit temporarily sets inhibit-quit to nil for use
3068 around potentially blocking or long-running code in timers
3069 and post-command-hooks.
3070
3071 ** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
3072 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
3073 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and may be overridden
3074 by them).
3075
3076 +++
3077 ** New face attribute `min-colors' can be used to tailor the face color
3078 to the number of colors supported by a display, and define the
3079 foreground and background colors accordingly so that they look best on
3080 a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This is now the
3081 preferred method for defining default faces in a way that makes a good
3082 use of the capabilities of the display.
3083
3084 +++
3085 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
3086
3087 *** New function 'define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
3088 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
3089
3090 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
3091 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
3092
3093 *** New function 'destroy-fringe-bitmap' may be used to destroy a
3094 previously created bitmap, or restore a built-in bitmap.
3095
3096 *** New function 'set-fringe-bitmap-face' can now be used to set a
3097 specific face to be used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is
3098 automatically merged with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face
3099 should only specify the foreground color of the bitmap.
3100
3101 *** There are new display properties, left-fringe and right-fringe,
3102 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
3103 bitmap of the display line.
3104
3105 Format is 'display '(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE]), where BITMAP is a
3106 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
3107 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
3108 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
3109 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
3110
3111 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
3112 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
3113
3114 +++
3115 ** Multiple overlay arrows can now be defined and managed via the new
3116 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'. It contains a list of
3117 varibles which contain overlay arrow position markers, including
3118 the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
3119
3120 Each variable on this list may have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
3121 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
3122 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
3123 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
3124 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
3125 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
3126
3127 +++
3128 ** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns line number of current
3129 line in current buffer, or if optional buffer position is given, line
3130 number of corresponding line in current buffer.
3131
3132 +++
3133 ** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3134 variable `sentence-end-without-space' which contains such characters
3135 that end a sentence without following spaces.
3136
3137 +++
3138 ** The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of
3139 the variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil,
3140 then this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3141 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3142 `sentence-end-without-space'.
3143
3144 +++
3145 ** The flags, width, and precision options for %-specifications in function
3146 `format' are now documented. Some flags that were accepted but not
3147 implemented (such as "*") are no longer accepted.
3148
3149 +++
3150 ** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3151 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3152 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3153 if no expansion is done, which may be tested using `eq'.
3154
3155 +++
3156 ** New function `delete-dups' destructively removes `equal' duplicates
3157 from a list. Of several `equal' occurrences of an element in the list,
3158 the first one is kept.
3159
3160 +++
3161 ** `declare' is now a macro. This change was made mostly for
3162 documentation purposes and should have no real effect on Lisp code.
3163
3164 +++
3165 ** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
3166 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
3167 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
3168 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
3169
3170 +++
3171 ** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3172 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3173 string. The old behavior is available if you call
3174 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
3175
3176 +++
3177 ** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
3178 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
3179 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
3180 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
3181 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
3182
3183 +++ (lispref)
3184 ??? (man)
3185 ** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
3186 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
3187 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
3188 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
3189 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
3190
3191 +++
3192 ** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
3193 :pointer image property.
3194
3195 +++
3196 ** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images may now be
3197 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
3198
3199 +++
3200 ** Images may now have an associated image map via the :map property.
3201
3202 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
3203 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
3204 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
3205 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
3206 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
3207 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
3208 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
3209 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
3210
3211 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
3212 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
3213 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
3214 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
3215 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable 'void-area-text-pointer'
3216 for possible pointer shapes.
3217
3218 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
3219 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
3220 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
3221
3222 ** Mouse event enhancements:
3223
3224 +++
3225 *** Mouse clicks on fringes now generates left-fringe or right-fringes
3226 events, rather than a text area click event.
3227
3228 +++
3229 *** Mouse clicks in the left and right marginal areas now includes a
3230 sensible buffer position corresponding to the first character in the
3231 corresponding text row.
3232
3233 +++
3234 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
3235
3236 +++
3237 *** Mouse events now includes buffer position for all event types.
3238
3239 +++
3240 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
3241
3242 +++
3243 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
3244 text area).
3245
3246 +++
3247 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types.
3248
3249 +++
3250 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns actual glyph coordinates.
3251
3252 +++
3253 *** Mouse events may now include image object in addition to string object.
3254
3255 +++
3256 *** Mouse events include relative x and y pixel coordinates relative to
3257 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
3258
3259 +++
3260 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
3261 (image or character) clicked on.
3262
3263 +++
3264 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', and
3265 'posn-object-width-height' return the image or string object of a mouse
3266 click, the x and y pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner
3267 of that object, and the total width and height of that object.
3268
3269 +++
3270 ** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
3271 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
3272 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
3273 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
3274 forcing an explicit window update.
3275
3276 ---
3277 ** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
3278 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
3279
3280 +++
3281 ** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3282 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3283 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3284 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3285 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3286
3287 +++
3288 ** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3289
3290 +++
3291 ** If optional third argument APPEND to `add-to-list' is non-nil, a
3292 new element gets added at the end of the list instead of at the
3293 beginning. This change actually occurred in Emacs-21.1, but was not
3294 documented.
3295
3296 ** Major modes can define `eldoc-print-current-symbol-info-function'
3297 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
3298 the language.
3299
3300 ---
3301 ** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
3302 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
3303 parts, e.g. utf-16.
3304
3305 +++
3306 ** The argument to forward-word, backward-word, forward-to-indentation
3307 and backward-to-indentation is now optional, and defaults to 1.
3308
3309 +++
3310 ** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
3311 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
3312 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
3313
3314 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
3315 does that, this value may not be accurate.
3316
3317 +++
3318 ** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
3319 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
3320 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
3321 the mode line.
3322
3323 +++
3324 ** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
3325 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
3326
3327 +++
3328 ** The kill-buffer-hook is now permanent-local.
3329
3330 +++
3331 ** `select-window' takes an optional second argument `norecord', like
3332 `switch-to-buffer'.
3333
3334 +++
3335 ** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
3336 selected window without impacting the order of buffer-list.
3337
3338 +++
3339 ** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
3340 text-properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
3341 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
3342
3343 +++
3344 ** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
3345 in the keymap.
3346
3347 ---
3348 ** VC changes for backends:
3349 *** (vc-switches BACKEND OPERATION) is a new function for use by backends.
3350 *** The new `find-version' backend function replaces the `destfile'
3351 parameter of the `checkout' backend function.
3352 Old code still works thanks to a default `find-version' behavior that
3353 uses the old `destfile' parameter.
3354
3355 +++
3356 ** The new macro dynamic-completion-table supports using functions
3357 as a dynamic completion table.
3358
3359 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
3360
3361 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
3362 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
3363 completions. This alist may be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
3364 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
3365 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
3366 entered. dynamic-completion-table then computes the completion.
3367
3368 +++
3369 ** The new macro lazy-completion-table initializes a variable
3370 as a lazy completion table.
3371
3372 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
3373
3374 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
3375 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
3376 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
3377 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
3378 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
3379 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
3380
3381 +++
3382 ** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
3383
3384 +++
3385 ** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
3386 for all (existing and future) frames.
3387
3388 +++
3389 ** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
3390
3391 +++
3392 ** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
3393
3394 +++
3395 ** The macro `with-syntax-table' does not copy the table any more.
3396
3397 +++
3398 ** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
3399 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
3400 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
3401 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
3402 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
3403
3404 +++
3405 ** The function `number-sequence' returns a list of equally-separated
3406 numbers. For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9).
3407 By default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different separation
3408 as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3409
3410 +++
3411 ** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
3412 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
3413 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
3414 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
3415
3416 ---
3417 ** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
3418 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
3419
3420 +++
3421 ** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character,
3422 unless it is followed by a `-' in a character constant (e.g. ?\s-A),
3423 in which case it is still interpreted as the super modifier.
3424 In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3425
3426 +++
3427 ** New function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the multibyteness
3428 of a string given to a process's filter.
3429
3430 +++
3431 ** New function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns t if
3432 a string given to a process's filter is multibyte.
3433
3434 +++
3435 ** A filter function of a process is called with a multibyte string if
3436 the filter's multibyteness is t. That multibyteness is decided by the
3437 value of `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is
3438 created and can be changed later by `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
3439
3440 +++
3441 ** If a process's coding system is raw-text or no-conversion and its
3442 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
3443 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
3444 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
3445 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
3446
3447 +++
3448 ** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3449 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3450
3451 +++
3452 ** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
3453 on garbage collection.
3454
3455 +++
3456 ** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
3457 it is read from a file without decoding.
3458
3459 +++
3460 ** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
3461
3462 +++
3463 ** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
3464 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
3465 by calling `select-window'.
3466
3467 ---
3468 ** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
3469 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
3470 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
3471 need to have a name.
3472
3473 ** Byte compiler changes:
3474
3475 ---
3476 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
3477 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
3478 Emacs and XEmacs and may sometimes make the result significantly more
3479 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
3480 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
3481 you anything.
3482
3483 +++
3484 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
3485 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
3486 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
3487 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
3488 forms:
3489
3490 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
3491 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
3492
3493 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
3494 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
3495 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
3496 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
3497 macro expansion), but such tests may be nested. Note that `when' and
3498 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
3499
3500 +++
3501 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
3502 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
3503
3504 +++
3505 ** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3506 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3507 be inserted is translated through it.
3508
3509 +++
3510 ** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
3511 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
3512 current file redefined it).
3513
3514 +++
3515 ** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
3516 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
3517
3518 +++
3519 ** New Lisp library testcover.el works with edebug to help you determine
3520 whether you've tested all your Lisp code. Function testcover-start
3521 instruments all functions in a given file. Then test your code. Function
3522 testcover-mark-all adds overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to
3523 show where coverage is lacking. Command testcover-next-mark (bind it to
3524 a key!) will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
3525
3526 *** Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely evaluated;
3527 a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same value. The red
3528 splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly complete their evaluation,
3529 such as `error'. The brown splotches are skipped for forms that are expected
3530 to always evaluate to the same value, such as (setq x 14).
3531
3532 *** For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to help
3533 out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a red splotch.
3534 It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does return. The macro 1value
3535 suppresses a brown splotch for its argument. This macro is a no-op except
3536 during test-coverage -- then it signals an error if the argument actually
3537 returns differing values.
3538
3539 +++
3540 ** New function unsafep returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly
3541 do anything dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be
3542 unsafe (calls dangerous function, alters global variable, etc).
3543
3544 +++
3545 ** The new variable `print-continuous-numbering', when non-nil, says
3546 that successive calls to print functions should use the same
3547 numberings for circular structure references. This is only relevant
3548 when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3549
3550 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3551 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3552
3553 +++
3554 ** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
3555 the scroll-bar-width frame parameter value is nil.
3556
3557 +++
3558 ** The new function copy-abbrev-table returns a new abbrev table that
3559 is a copy of a given abbrev table.
3560
3561 +++
3562 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
3563 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
3564 can start with this line:
3565
3566 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
3567
3568 +++
3569 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
3570 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
3571 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
3572
3573 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
3574
3575 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
3576 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
3577
3578 +++
3579 ** A function's docstring can now hold the function's usage info on
3580 its last line. It should match the regexp "\n\n(fn.*)\\'".
3581
3582 ---
3583 ** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
3584 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
3585
3586 +++
3587 ** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional buffer
3588 argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted it defaults to
3589 the current buffer.
3590
3591 +++
3592 ** There is a new Warnings facility; see the functions `warn'
3593 and `display-warning'.
3594
3595 +++
3596 ** The functions all-completions and try-completion now accept lists
3597 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3598 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
3599 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables may be either
3600 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
3601
3602 ---
3603 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
3604 much pure storage it will approximately need.
3605
3606 +++
3607 ** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
3608 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
3609 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
3610 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
3611
3612 ---
3613 ** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
3614 of one coding system from another coding system.
3615
3616 +++
3617 ** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3618 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3619 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3620 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3621 needed.
3622
3623 ---
3624 ** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3625 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3626 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3627 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3628 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3629 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3630
3631 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3632 confirmation as before.
3633
3634 +++
3635 ** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
3636
3637 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
3638 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
3639 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
3640 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
3641
3642 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
3643 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
3644 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
3645 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
3646 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
3647 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
3648
3649 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
3650 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
3651 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
3652 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
3653
3654 +++
3655 ** Per-window fringes settings
3656
3657 Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and position
3658 settings.
3659
3660 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
3661 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
3662 `set-window-fringes'.
3663
3664 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
3665 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
3666 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
3667 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
3668
3669 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
3670 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
3671 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
3672 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
3673 an update of the display margins.
3674
3675 +++
3676 ** Per-window vertical scroll-bar settings
3677
3678 Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
3679 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
3680
3681 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
3682 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
3683 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
3684 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
3685 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
3686 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
3687 of the display margins.
3688
3689 +++
3690 ** The function `set-window-buffer' now has an optional third argument
3691 KEEP-MARGINS which will preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
3692 and scroll-bar settings if non-nil.
3693
3694 +++
3695 ** Renamed hooks to better follow the naming convention:
3696 find-file-hooks to find-file-hook,
3697 find-file-not-found-hooks to find-file-not-found-functions,
3698 write-file-hooks to write-file-functions,
3699 write-contents-hooks to write-contents-functions,
3700 x-lost-selection-hooks to x-lost-selection-functions,
3701 x-sent-selection-hooks to x-sent-selection-functions.
3702 Marked local-write-file-hooks as obsolete (use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook').
3703
3704 +++
3705 ** The new variable `delete-frame-functions' replaces `delete-frame-hook'.
3706 It was renamed to follow the naming conventions for abnormal hooks. The old
3707 name remains available as an alias, but has been marked obsolete.
3708
3709 +++
3710 ** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3711 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3712 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3713 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3714 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3715
3716 ---
3717 ** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by lisp code
3718 to override the internal read-file-name function.
3719
3720 +++
3721 ** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3722 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3723 `read-file-name' function.
3724
3725 +++
3726 ** The new function `read-directory-name' can be used instead of
3727 `read-file-name' to read a directory name; when used, completion
3728 will only show directories.
3729
3730 +++
3731 ** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3732 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3733 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
3734 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
3735
3736 ---
3737 ** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
3738 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
3739 (require 'cl) when loaded.
3740
3741 +++
3742 ** The `defmacro' form may contain declarations specifying how to
3743 indent the macro in Lisp mode and how to debug it with Edebug. The
3744 syntax of defmacro has been extended to
3745
3746 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3747
3748 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3749 declaration specifiers supported are:
3750
3751 (indent INDENT)
3752 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3753
3754 (edebug DEBUG)
3755 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3756 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro.
3757
3758 +++
3759 ** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3760
3761 This is an alternative to using defadvice or substitute-key-definition
3762 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
3763 binding and lookup functionality.
3764
3765 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3766 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3767 original command.
3768
3769 Example:
3770 Suppose that minor mode my-mode has defined the commands
3771 my-kill-line and my-kill-word, and it wants C-k (and any other key
3772 bound to kill-line) to run the command my-kill-line instead of
3773 kill-line, and likewise it wants to run my-kill-word instead of
3774 kill-word.
3775
3776 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3777 command remapping allows you to directly map kill-line into
3778 my-kill-line and kill-word into my-kill-word through the minor mode
3779 map using define-key:
3780
3781 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3782 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
3783
3784 Now, when my-mode is enabled, and the user enters C-k or M-d,
3785 the commands my-kill-line and my-kill-word are run.
3786
3787 Notice that only one level of remapping is supported. In the above
3788 example, this means that if my-kill-line is remapped to other-kill,
3789 then C-k still runs my-kill-line.
3790
3791 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3792
3793 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3794 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3795 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3796 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
3797
3798 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3799 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
3800
3801 - key-binding now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
3802 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
3803
3804 - where-is-internal now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3805 kill-line if my-mode is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3806 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3807 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3808 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns C-k for kill-line and
3809 <kill-line> for my-kill-line).
3810
3811 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3812 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3813 command was not remapped.
3814
3815 +++
3816 ** New variable emulation-mode-map-alists.
3817
3818 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3819 keymap alist separate from minor-mode-map-alist by adding their keymap
3820 alist to this list.
3821
3822 +++
3823 ** Atomic change groups.
3824
3825 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3826 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3827 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3828
3829 (atomic-change-group
3830 (insert foo)
3831 (delete-region x y))
3832
3833 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3834 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3835 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3836 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3837
3838 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3839 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3840
3841 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3842 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3843 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3844 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3845
3846 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3847 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3848 do this.
3849
3850 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3851 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3852 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3853 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3854
3855 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3856 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3857 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3858 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3859 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3860 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3861 twice.
3862
3863 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3864 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3865 returned values, like this:
3866
3867 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3868 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3869
3870 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3871 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3872 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3873
3874 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3875 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3876 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3877 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3878 finished.
3879
3880 +++
3881 ** New variable char-property-alias-alist.
3882
3883 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
3884 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
3885 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
3886 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
3887
3888 +++
3889 ** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
3890
3891 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
3892 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
3893 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
3894 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
3895
3896 +++
3897 ** New function remove-list-of-text-properties.
3898
3899 The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties' is almost the same
3900 as `remove-text-properties'. The only difference is that it takes
3901 a list of property names as argument rather than a property list.
3902
3903 +++
3904 ** New function insert-for-yank.
3905
3906 This function normally works like `insert' but removes the text
3907 properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list. However, if the
3908 inserted text has a `yank-handler' text property on the first
3909 character of the string, the insertion of the text may be modified in
3910 a number of ways. See the description of `yank-handler' below.
3911
3912 +++
3913 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-as-yank.
3914
3915 This function works like `insert-buffer-substring', but removes the
3916 text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list.
3917
3918 +++
3919 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
3920
3921 This function is like insert-buffer-substring, but removes all
3922 text properties from the inserted substring.
3923
3924 +++
3925 ** New `yank-handler' text property may be used to control how
3926 previously killed text on the kill-ring is reinserted.
3927
3928 The value of the yank-handler property must be a list with one to four
3929 elements with the following format:
3930 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3931
3932 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3933 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3934 element on the kill-ring). If a yank-handler property is found,
3935 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3936
3937 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3938 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3939 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3940 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3941 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3942 rectangle.
3943 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3944 yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3945 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3946 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3947 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3948 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3949 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
3950 FUNCTION may set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
3951
3952 +++
3953 *** The functions kill-new, kill-append, and kill-region now have an
3954 optional argument to specify the yank-handler text property to put on
3955 the killed text.
3956
3957 +++
3958 *** The function yank-pop will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3959 `yank-undo-function' (instead of delete-region) to undo the previous
3960 yank or yank-pop command (or a call to insert-for-yank). The function
3961 insert-for-yank automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3962 element of the string argument's yank-handler text property if present.
3963
3964 +++
3965 ** New function display-supports-face-attributes-p may be used to test
3966 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
3967
3968 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
3969 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
3970 defined with defface.
3971
3972 ---
3973 ** The function face-differs-from-default-p now truly checks whether the
3974 given face displays differently from the default face or not (previously
3975 it did only a very cursory check).
3976
3977 +++
3978 ** face-attribute, face-foreground, face-background, and face-stipple now
3979 accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how face
3980 inheritance is used when determining the value of a face attribute.
3981
3982 +++
3983 ** New functions face-attribute-relative-p and merge-face-attribute
3984 help with handling relative face attributes.
3985
3986 +++
3987 ** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face-list is reversed.
3988 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
3989 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous releases
3990 of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made so that
3991 :inherit face-lists operate identically to face-lists in text `face'
3992 properties.
3993
3994 +++
3995 ** Enhancements to process support
3996
3997 *** Function list-processes now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
3998 only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set are listed.
3999
4000 *** New set-process-query-on-exit-flag and process-query-on-exit-flag
4001 functions. The existing process-kill-without-query function is still
4002 supported, but new code should use the new functions.
4003
4004 *** Function signal-process now accepts a process object or process
4005 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
4006
4007 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
4008 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
4009
4010 The new functions process-get and process-put are used to access, add,
4011 and modify elements on this property list.
4012
4013 The new low-level functions process-plist and set-process-plist are
4014 used to access and replace the entire property list of a process.
4015
4016 *** Function accept-process-output now has an optional fourth arg
4017 `just-this-one'. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
4018 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
4019 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
4020 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
4021 speech synthesis.
4022
4023 ---
4024 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
4025
4026 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
4027 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4028 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
4029 by setting the new variable process-adaptive-read-buffering to a
4030 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
4031 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
4032 emacs tries to read it.
4033
4034 +++
4035 ** Enhanced networking support.
4036
4037 *** There is a new `make-network-process' function which supports
4038 opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
4039 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
4040
4041 - A server is started using :server t arg.
4042 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
4043 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
4044 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
4045 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
4046 - The process' property list may be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
4047 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
4048 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
4049
4050 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
4051 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
4052
4053 *** Original open-network-stream is now emulated using make-network-process.
4054
4055 *** New function open-network-stream-nowait.
4056
4057 This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
4058 without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
4059 filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
4060 connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
4061 matching "open" or "failed".
4062
4063 *** New function open-network-stream-server.
4064
4065 This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
4066 When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
4067 is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
4068 is called for the new process.
4069
4070 *** New functions process-datagram-address and set-process-datagram-address.
4071
4072 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
4073 and set the current address of the remote partner.
4074
4075 *** New function format-network-address.
4076
4077 This function reformats the lisp representation of a network address
4078 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
4079 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
4080 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
4081 string for other formatting options.
4082
4083 *** By default, the function process-contact still returns (HOST SERVICE)
4084 for a network process. Using the new optional KEY arg, the complete list
4085 of network process properties or a specific property can be selected.
4086
4087 Using :local and :remote as the KEY, the address of the local or
4088 remote end-point is returned. An Inet address is represented as a 5
4089 element vector, where the first 4 elements contain the IP address and
4090 the fifth is the port number.
4091
4092 *** Network processes can now be stopped and restarted with
4093 `stop-process' and `continue-process'. For a server process, no
4094 connections are accepted in the stopped state. For a client process,
4095 no input is received in the stopped state.
4096
4097 *** New function network-interface-list.
4098
4099 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4100 current network addresses.
4101
4102 *** New function network-interface-info.
4103
4104 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4105 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4106
4107 +++
4108 ** New function copy-tree.
4109
4110 +++
4111 ** New function substring-no-properties.
4112
4113 +++
4114 ** New function minibuffer-selected-window.
4115
4116 +++
4117 ** New function `call-process-shell-command'.
4118
4119 +++
4120 ** New function `process-file'.
4121
4122 This is similar to `call-process', but obeys file handlers. The file
4123 handler is chosen based on default-directory.
4124
4125 ---
4126 ** The dummy function keys made by easymenu
4127 are now always lower case. If you specify the
4128 menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
4129 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
4130
4131 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for
4132 the bindings that were made with easymenu.
4133
4134 +++
4135 ** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional
4136 argument. If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks
4137 for a function that could be called with `call-interactively',
4138 and does not return t for keyboard macros.
4139
4140 ---
4141 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
4142 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
4143
4144 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
4145 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
4146 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
4147 commands.
4148
4149 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
4150 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
4151 SQL buffer.
4152
4153 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
4154 (function (lambda ()
4155 (master-mode t)
4156 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4157 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
4158 (function (lambda ()
4159 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4160
4161 +++
4162 ** File local variables.
4163
4164 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
4165 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
4166
4167 +++
4168 ** New function window-body-height.
4169
4170 This is like window-height but does not count the mode line
4171 or the header line.
4172
4173 +++
4174 ** New function format-mode-line.
4175
4176 This returns the mode-line or header-line of the selected (or a
4177 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
4178
4179 +++
4180 ** New function safe-plist-get.
4181
4182 This function is like plist-get, but never signals an error for
4183 a malformed property list.
4184
4185 +++
4186 ** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
4187
4188 These functions are like `plist-get' and `plist-put' except that they
4189 compare the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
4190
4191 +++
4192 ** New function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu'
4193
4194 The `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' must not be used (as previously
4195 recommended) for making entries in the tool bar for local keymaps.
4196 Instead, use the function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu', which lets
4197 you specify the map to use as an argument.
4198
4199 +++
4200 ** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
4201
4202 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
4203 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
4204 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
4205
4206 +++
4207 ** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4208
4209 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4210 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4211 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4212 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4213 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4214
4215 +++
4216 ** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
4217 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
4218 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
4219 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
4220
4221 +++
4222 ** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
4223 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
4224
4225 +++
4226 ** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
4227 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
4228 line.
4229
4230 ---
4231 ** Indentation of simple and extended loop forms has been added to the
4232 cl-indent package. The new user options
4233 `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation', `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and
4234 `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can be used to customize the
4235 indentation of keywords and forms in loop forms.
4236
4237 ---
4238 ** Indentation of backquoted forms has been made customizable in the
4239 cl-indent package. See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
4240
4241 +++
4242 ** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
4243
4244 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
4245 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
4246 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
4247 now:
4248
4249 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
4250
4251 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
4252 the time it takes to convert the format.
4253
4254 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
4255 wasteful.
4256
4257 +++
4258 ** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
4259 over minor mode keymaps.
4260
4261 +++
4262 ** A hex escape in a string forces the string to be multibyte.
4263 An octal escape makes it unibyte.
4264
4265 +++
4266 ** At the end of a command, point moves out from within invisible
4267 text, in the same way it moves out from within text covered by an
4268 image or composition property.
4269
4270 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
4271 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
4272 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
4273 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
4274 post-command-hook and thus does not care about intermediate states.
4275
4276 +++
4277 ** field-beginning and field-end now accept an additional optional
4278 argument, LIMIT.
4279
4280 +++
4281 ** define-abbrev now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG. If
4282 non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means that
4283 it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the abbrevs.
4284 Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always specify this
4285 flag.
4286
4287 ---
4288 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
4289
4290 ---
4291 ** The function insert-string is now obsolete.
4292
4293 ---
4294 ** The precedence of file-name-handlers has been changed.
4295 Instead of blindly choosing the first handler that matches,
4296 find-file-name-handler now gives precedence to a file-name handler
4297 that matches near the end of the file name. More specifically, the
4298 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen.
4299 In case of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
4300
4301 ---
4302 ** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
4303 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
4304 bindings of the parent keymap.
4305
4306 ---
4307 ** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
4308 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
4309 (see jit-lock-defer-contextually), then all of that text will
4310 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
4311 depends on text several lines further down (and when font-lock-multiline
4312 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
4313
4314 s{
4315 foo
4316 }{
4317 bar
4318 }e
4319
4320 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
4321 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a jit-lock-defer-multiline
4322 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
4323 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
4324
4325 ---
4326 ** describe-vector now takes a second argument `describer' which is
4327 called to print the entries' values. It defaults to `princ'.
4328
4329 +++
4330 ** defcustom and other custom declarations now use a default group
4331 (the last prior group defined in the same file) when no :group was given.
4332
4333 +++
4334 ** emacsserver now runs pre-command-hook and post-command-hook when
4335 it receives a request from emacsclient.
4336
4337 ---
4338 ** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
4339 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
4340 than 3 levels of nesting.
4341
4342 ---
4343 ** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
4344 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
4345 it in that buffer.
4346
4347 ---
4348 ** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
4349 properties from surrounding text.
4350
4351 +++
4352 ** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
4353 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
4354 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
4355
4356 +++
4357 ** New function `buffer-local-value'.
4358
4359 This function returns the buffer-local binding of VARIABLE (a symbol)
4360 in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not have a buffer-local binding in
4361 buffer BUFFER, it returns the default value of VARIABLE instead.
4362
4363 ---
4364 ** New function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
4365 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
4366 clone to the other.
4367
4368 +++
4369 ** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
4370 *** the FACENAME returned in font-lock-keywords can be a list
4371 of the form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set
4372 other properties than `face'.
4373 *** font-lock-extra-managed-props can be set to make sure those extra
4374 properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
4375
4376 ---
4377 ** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4378 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4379 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4380 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4381 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
4382
4383 +++
4384 ** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
4385 are used by define-derived-mode to make sure the mode hook for the
4386 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
4387
4388 +++
4389 ** define-minor-mode now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
4390 and simply passes them to defcustom, if applicable.
4391
4392 +++
4393 ** define-derived-mode by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
4394 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
4395
4396 +++
4397 ** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
4398 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
4399 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
4400
4401 +++
4402 ** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
4403 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
4404 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
4405
4406 +++
4407 ** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
4408 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
4409 accepts a float as UID parameter.
4410
4411 ---
4412 ** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
4413
4414 +++
4415 ** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in elisp files is now obeyed.
4416
4417 +++
4418 ** The Emacs Lisp byte-compiler now displays the actual line and
4419 character position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form
4420 of its warning and error messages have been brought more in line with
4421 the output of other GNU tools.
4422
4423 +++
4424 ** New functions `keymap-prompt' and `current-active-maps'.
4425
4426 ---
4427 ** New function `describe-buffer-bindings'.
4428
4429 +++
4430 ** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
4431 searching for an executable resp. an elisp file.
4432
4433 +++
4434 ** Variable aliases have been implemented:
4435
4436 *** defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
4437
4438 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
4439 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
4440 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
4441 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
4442
4443 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
4444 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
4445
4446 *** indirect-variable VARIABLE
4447
4448 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
4449 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
4450 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
4451
4452 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
4453 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
4454
4455 +++
4456 ** Functions from `post-gc-hook' are run at the end of garbage
4457 collection. The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
4458
4459 +++
4460 ** If the second argument to `copy-file' is the name of a directory,
4461 the file is copied to that directory instead of signaling an error.
4462
4463 +++
4464 ** The variables most-positive-fixnum and most-negative-fixnum
4465 hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
4466
4467 ---
4468 ** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4469 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4470 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
4471
4472 ---
4473 ** Functions y-or-n-p, read-char, read-key-sequence and the like, that
4474 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
4475 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
4476
4477 ---
4478 ** New function x-send-client-message sends a client message when
4479 running under X.
4480
4481 +++
4482 ** Arguments for remove-overlays are now optional, so that you can remove
4483 all overlays in the buffer by just calling (remove-overlay).
4484
4485 ** New packages:
4486
4487 +++
4488 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
4489 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
4490 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
4491 state of your program. It separates the input/output of your program from
4492 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
4493 Emacs 21 such as the display margin for breakpoints, and the toolbar.
4494
4495 Use M-x gdba to start GDB-UI.
4496
4497 *** The new package syntax.el provides an efficient way to find the
4498 current syntactic context (as returned by parse-partial-sexp).
4499
4500 *** The new package bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
4501 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
4502 data structures.
4503
4504 ---
4505 *** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
4506 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
4507
4508 +++
4509 *** The new package button.el implements simple and fast `clickable buttons'
4510 in emacs buffers. `buttons' are much lighter-weight than the `widgets'
4511 implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that doesn't
4512 require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for such things
4513 as help and apropos buffers.
4514
4515 \f
4516 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
4517
4518 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
4519 been added.
4520
4521 \f
4522 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
4523
4524 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
4525 with Custom.
4526
4527 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
4528 as mule-utf-8.
4529
4530 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
4531 in UTF-8 locales).
4532
4533 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
4534 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
4535 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
4536 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
4537 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
4538 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
4539 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
4540 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
4541 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
4542 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
4543
4544 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
4545 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
4546
4547 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
4548 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
4549 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
4550 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
4551 contrary to the compound text specification.
4552
4553 \f
4554 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
4555
4556 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
4557
4558 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
4559
4560 \f
4561 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
4562
4563 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
4564
4565 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
4566 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
4567 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
4568 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
4569 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
4570
4571 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
4572 were changed.
4573
4574 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
4575 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
4576
4577 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
4578 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
4579 instead of using default-major-mode.
4580
4581 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
4582 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
4583 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
4584 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
4585 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
4586 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
4587 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
4588
4589 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
4590 NEWS.
4591
4592 \f
4593 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
4594
4595 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
4596 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
4597 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
4598
4599 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
4600 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
4601
4602 \f
4603 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
4604
4605 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
4606 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
4607 charsets in this release.
4608
4609 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
4610
4611 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
4612
4613 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
4614 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
4615 to list them.
4616
4617 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
4618 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
4619 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
4620 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
4621 necessary changes to unexec.
4622
4623 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
4624 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
4625
4626 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
4627 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
4628
4629 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
4630 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
4631
4632 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
4633 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
4634 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
4635 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
4636 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
4637
4638 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
4639 new display features described below.
4640
4641 \f
4642 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
4643
4644 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
4645
4646 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
4647 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
4648 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
4649 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
4650 the text.
4651
4652 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
4653
4654 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
4655 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
4656 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
4657 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
4658 specify a font.
4659
4660 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
4661 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
4662 under Lisp changes, below.
4663
4664 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
4665
4666 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
4667 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
4668 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
4669 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
4670 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
4671 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
4672 on terminals.
4673
4674 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
4675 supported on character terminals.
4676
4677 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
4678 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
4679 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
4680 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
4681
4682 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
4683
4684 ** Sound support
4685
4686 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
4687 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
4688 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
4689 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
4690 sound support.
4691
4692 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
4693
4694 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
4695 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
4696 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
4697 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
4698
4699 - User option: max-mini-window-height
4700
4701 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
4702 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
4703 specifies a number of lines.
4704
4705 Default is 0.25.
4706
4707 - User option: resize-mini-windows
4708
4709 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
4710 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
4711 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
4712 again.
4713
4714 Default is `grow-only'.
4715
4716 ** LessTif support.
4717
4718 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
4719 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
4720
4721 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
4722
4723 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
4724 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
4725 non-nil.
4726
4727 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
4728
4729 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
4730 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
4731 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
4732
4733 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
4734
4735 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
4736 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
4737 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
4738 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
4739 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
4740 Emacs.
4741
4742 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
4743 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
4744 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
4745 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
4746 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
4747 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
4748
4749 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
4750 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
4751 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
4752 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
4753 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
4754 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
4755
4756 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
4757 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
4758 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
4759 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
4760 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
4761
4762 ** Tool bar support.
4763
4764 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
4765 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
4766 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
4767 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
4768 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
4769 icons will be used.
4770
4771 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
4772 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
4773
4774 ** Tooltips.
4775
4776 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
4777 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
4778 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
4779
4780 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
4781 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
4782 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
4783 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
4784
4785 ** Automatic Hscrolling
4786
4787 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
4788 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
4789 customized.
4790
4791 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
4792 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
4793 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
4794 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
4795 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
4796
4797 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
4798 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
4799 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
4800 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
4801 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
4802 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
4803
4804 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
4805 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
4806 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
4807 customizing face `fringe'.
4808
4809 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
4810 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
4811 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
4812 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
4813 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
4814 the window to be partially obscured.)
4815
4816 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
4817 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
4818 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
4819 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
4820
4821 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
4822
4823 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
4824 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
4825 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
4826 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
4827 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
4828 have enabled one.
4829
4830 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
4831
4832 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
4833
4834 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
4835
4836 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
4837 `*') toggles the status.
4838
4839 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
4840
4841 ** Hourglass pointer
4842
4843 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
4844 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
4845
4846 ** Blinking cursor
4847
4848 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
4849 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
4850 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
4851 the group `cursor'.
4852
4853 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
4854
4855 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
4856 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
4857 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
4858 details.
4859
4860 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
4861 have to do anything to activate it.
4862
4863 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
4864
4865 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
4866 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
4867
4868 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
4869 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
4870 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
4871 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
4872 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
4873 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
4874 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
4875 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
4876
4877 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
4878 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
4879 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
4880 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
4881 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
4882 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
4883
4884 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
4885 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
4886
4887 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
4888 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
4889 buffer by default.
4890
4891 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
4892 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
4893 beginning and end of the buffer.
4894
4895 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
4896 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
4897 signaled.
4898
4899 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
4900 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
4901
4902 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
4903 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
4904 this behavior.
4905
4906 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
4907 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
4908 Emacs dump core.
4909
4910 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
4911
4912 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
4913 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
4914 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
4915
4916 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
4917 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
4918 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
4919
4920 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
4921 using that menu.
4922
4923 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
4924
4925 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
4926 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
4927 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
4928 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
4929 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
4930 whitespace.
4931
4932 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
4933 all frames except the selected one.
4934
4935 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
4936 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
4937
4938 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
4939 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
4940 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
4941 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
4942 `Info-use-header-line'.
4943
4944 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
4945 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
4946 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
4947
4948 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
4949
4950 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
4951 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
4952 `fr-drdref.tex'.
4953
4954 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
4955 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
4956 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
4957 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
4958
4959 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
4960
4961 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
4962 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
4963 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
4964 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
4965
4966 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
4967 point in a pop-up window.
4968
4969 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
4970 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
4971 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
4972
4973 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
4974 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
4975
4976 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
4977 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
4978 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
4979 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
4980
4981 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
4982
4983 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
4984 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
4985
4986 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
4987 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
4988 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
4989
4990 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
4991 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
4992 non-nil.
4993
4994 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
4995 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
4996 file that is already visited under a different name.
4997
4998 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
4999 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5000
5001 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5002 and displays information about that.
5003
5004 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5005 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5006
5007 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5008 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5009 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5010 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5011 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5012 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5013
5014 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5015 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5016
5017 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5018 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5019 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5020 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5021 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5022 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5023 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5024
5025 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5026 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5027
5028 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5029 system for keyboard input.
5030
5031 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5032 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5033 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5034 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5035 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5036 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5037 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5038 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5039 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5040
5041 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5042 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5043
5044 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5045 displays all characters in that character set.
5046
5047 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5048 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5049
5050 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5051 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5052 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5053
5054 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5055 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5056 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5057 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5058 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5059 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5060 and Polish `slash'.
5061
5062 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5063 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5064 of the tutorial.
5065
5066 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5067 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5068 Lisp Coding Convention".
5069
5070 new command old-binding
5071 --- ------- -----------
5072 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5073 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5074 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
5075
5076 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
5077 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
5078 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
5079
5080 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
5081 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
5082 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
5083 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
5084 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
5085 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
5086
5087 ** There are new Leim input methods.
5088 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
5089 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
5090 package.
5091
5092 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
5093 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
5094 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
5095 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
5096 "`", you must type "=q".
5097
5098 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
5099 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
5100 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
5101 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
5102 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
5103 on.
5104
5105 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
5106 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
5107 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
5108 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5109
5110 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
5111 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
5112 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
5113 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
5114
5115 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
5116 on the display using several methods
5117
5118 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
5119 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
5120 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
5121
5122 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5123 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
5124
5125 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
5126
5127 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
5128 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
5129
5130 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
5131 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
5132 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
5133 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
5134
5135 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
5136 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
5137 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
5138
5139 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
5140 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
5141
5142 ** New X resources recognized
5143
5144 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
5145 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
5146 is useful for debugging X problems.
5147
5148 Example:
5149
5150 emacs.synchronous: true
5151
5152 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
5153 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
5154 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
5155 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
5156 visual class names are
5157
5158 TrueColor
5159 PseudoColor
5160 DirectColor
5161 StaticColor
5162 GrayScale
5163 StaticGray
5164
5165 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
5166 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
5167 meaning.
5168
5169 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
5170 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
5171 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
5172 visual.
5173
5174 Example:
5175
5176 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
5177
5178 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
5179 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
5180 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
5181 resource values are `true' or `on'.
5182
5183 Example:
5184
5185 emacs.privateColormap: true
5186
5187 ** Faces and frame parameters.
5188
5189 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
5190 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
5191 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
5192 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
5193 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
5194 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
5195 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
5196
5197 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
5198 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
5199 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
5200 `default' face and vice versa.
5201
5202 ** New face `menu'.
5203
5204 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
5205
5206 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
5207
5208 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
5209 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
5210 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
5211 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
5212
5213 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
5214 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
5215 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
5216
5217 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
5218 `ScreenGamma'.
5219
5220 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
5221
5222 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
5223 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
5224 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
5225 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
5226
5227 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
5228
5229 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
5230
5231 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
5232
5233 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
5234 LessTif/Motif one.
5235
5236 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
5237 LessTif and Motif.
5238
5239 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
5240
5241 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
5242 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
5243 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
5244
5245 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
5246 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
5247
5248 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
5249 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
5250 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
5251
5252 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
5253
5254 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
5255 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
5256 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5257 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
5258
5259 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
5260 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
5261 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5262 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
5263
5264 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
5265 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
5266 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
5267 buffers.
5268
5269 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
5270
5271 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
5272 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
5273 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
5274
5275 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
5276 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
5277 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
5278 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
5279 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
5280 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
5281
5282 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
5283
5284 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
5285 notably at the end of lines.
5286
5287 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
5288 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
5289
5290 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
5291
5292 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
5293 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
5294
5295 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
5296 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
5297 after each match to get the replacement text.
5298
5299 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
5300 you edit the replacement string.
5301
5302 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
5303 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
5304 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
5305
5306 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
5307
5308 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
5309 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
5310
5311 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
5312 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
5313 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
5314 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
5315
5316 --
5317 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
5318 read mail from the menu etc.
5319
5320 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
5321 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
5322 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
5323 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
5324
5325 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
5326 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5327
5328 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
5329 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
5330 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
5331 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
5332 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
5333 of Emacs.
5334
5335 ** Customize changes
5336
5337 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
5338 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
5339 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
5340 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
5341 earlier versions of Emacs.
5342
5343 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
5344 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
5345 default).
5346
5347 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5348 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
5349 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
5350 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
5351 file.
5352
5353 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5354 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
5355 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
5356 already in your init file.
5357
5358 ** New features in evaluation commands
5359
5360 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
5361 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
5362 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
5363 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
5364 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
5365
5366 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
5367 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
5368 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
5369 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
5370 printed).
5371
5372 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
5373 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
5374
5375 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5376 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5377
5378 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5379 code when called with a prefix argument.
5380
5381 ** CC mode changes.
5382
5383 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
5384 current user setups (although it's believed that these
5385 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
5386 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
5387 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
5388 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
5389 release.
5390
5391 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
5392 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
5393 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
5394 confusion.
5395
5396 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
5397 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
5398 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
5399 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
5400
5401 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
5402 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
5403
5404 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
5405 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
5406
5407 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
5408 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
5409 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
5410 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
5411
5412 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
5413 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
5414 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
5415 earlier statement. An example:
5416
5417 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
5418 if (a[i])
5419 res += a[i]->offset;
5420 else
5421
5422 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
5423 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
5424 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
5425 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
5426 the preceding "if".
5427
5428 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
5429 by default.
5430
5431 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
5432 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
5433 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
5434 documentation or other natural language text.
5435
5436 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
5437 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
5438 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
5439 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
5440 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
5441 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
5442 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
5443
5444 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
5445 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
5446 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
5447 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
5448
5449 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
5450 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
5451 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
5452 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
5453 Pike mode only.
5454
5455 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
5456 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
5457 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
5458 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
5459 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
5460 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
5461 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
5462 is reported afterwards.
5463
5464 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
5465 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
5466 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
5467
5468 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
5469 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
5470 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
5471 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
5472 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
5473 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
5474 groundwork.
5475
5476 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
5477 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
5478 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
5479 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
5480 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
5481 have to bother.
5482
5483 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
5484 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
5485 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
5486 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
5487 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
5488 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
5489
5490 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
5491 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
5492 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
5493 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
5494 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
5495 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
5496 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
5497 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
5498
5499 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
5500 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
5501 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
5502 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
5503 above.
5504
5505 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
5506 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
5507 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
5508 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
5509 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
5510 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
5511 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
5512 function documentation for more info.
5513
5514 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
5515 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
5516 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
5517 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
5518 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
5519 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
5520 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
5521 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
5522
5523 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
5524
5525 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
5526 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
5527
5528 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
5529 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
5530 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
5531 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
5532 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
5533 style system.
5534
5535 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
5536 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
5537 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
5538 as far as possible.
5539
5540 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
5541 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
5542 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
5543 chapter about this in the manual.
5544
5545 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
5546 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
5547 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
5548 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
5549 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
5550
5551 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
5552 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
5553 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
5554
5555 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
5556 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
5557
5558 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
5559 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
5560 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
5561 inside CC Mode.
5562
5563 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
5564 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
5565 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
5566 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
5567 cc-mode/).
5568
5569 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
5570 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
5571 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
5572 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
5573 they were before the filling.
5574
5575 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
5576 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
5577 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
5578 literals.
5579
5580 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
5581 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
5582 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
5583 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
5584 this function.
5585
5586 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
5587 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
5588 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
5589 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
5590 Thanks to Eric Eide.
5591
5592 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
5593 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
5594 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
5595
5596 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
5597
5598 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
5599 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
5600 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
5601 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
5602
5603 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
5604 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
5605 the column specified by comment-column.
5606
5607 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
5608 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
5609 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
5610 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
5611 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
5612 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
5613
5614 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
5615 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
5616 arguments.
5617
5618 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
5619
5620 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
5621 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
5622 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
5623 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
5624 Provan).
5625
5626 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
5627
5628 ** Dired changes
5629
5630 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
5631 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
5632 is, delete only empty directories.
5633
5634 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
5635 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
5636 copy directories recursively.
5637
5638 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
5639 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
5640 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
5641
5642 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
5643 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
5644 directory.
5645
5646 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
5647 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
5648 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
5649 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
5650 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
5651
5652 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
5653 from ls switches.
5654
5655 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
5656 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
5657 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
5658 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
5659
5660 ** Gnus changes.
5661
5662 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
5663 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
5664 internationalization and mail-fetching.
5665
5666 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
5667 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
5668
5669 If you used procmail like in
5670
5671 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
5672 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
5673 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
5674 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
5675
5676 this now has changed to
5677
5678 (setq mail-sources
5679 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
5680 :suffix ".in")))
5681
5682 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
5683 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
5684
5685 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
5686 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
5687 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
5688 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
5689
5690 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
5691 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
5692 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
5693
5694 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
5695 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
5696 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
5697 now just a compatibility layer.
5698
5699 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
5700 Gnus facilities.
5701
5702 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
5703 called to position point.
5704
5705 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
5706 summary buffers and NOV files.
5707
5708 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
5709 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
5710
5711 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
5712 subtly different manner.
5713
5714 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
5715 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
5716 ever-changing layouts.
5717
5718 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
5719
5720 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
5721
5722 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
5723
5724 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
5725 macros
5726
5727 Key binding Macro
5728 -------------------------
5729 C-c C-c C-s @strong
5730 C-c C-c C-e @emph
5731 C-c C-c u @uref
5732 C-c C-c q @quotation
5733 C-c C-c m @email
5734 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
5735 M-RET @item
5736
5737 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
5738
5739 ** Changes in Outline mode.
5740
5741 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
5742 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
5743 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
5744
5745 ** Changes to Emacs Server
5746
5747 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
5748 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
5749 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
5750 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
5751 buffers to kill, as before.
5752
5753 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
5754 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
5755 this way.
5756
5757 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
5758 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
5759
5760 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
5761
5762 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
5763 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
5764 use. Default is 1000.
5765
5766 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
5767 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
5768
5769 ** Changes to hideshow.el
5770
5771 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
5772
5773 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
5774 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
5775 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
5776 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
5777
5778 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
5779 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
5780 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
5781 the open block.
5782
5783 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
5784 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
5785 the normal block-hiding function.
5786
5787 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
5788
5789 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
5790 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
5791 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
5792 for `hs-minor-mode'.
5793
5794 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
5795 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
5796
5797 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
5798
5799 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
5800 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
5801 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
5802
5803 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
5804 current buffer.
5805
5806 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
5807 in a log file.
5808
5809 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
5810 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
5811 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
5812 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
5813 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
5814 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
5815
5816 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
5817
5818 ** Changes to cmuscheme
5819
5820 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
5821 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
5822
5823 ** Changes in Font Lock
5824
5825 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
5826 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
5827
5828 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
5829 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
5830
5831 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
5832 the face used for each string/comment.
5833
5834 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
5835 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
5836
5837 ** Changes to Shell mode
5838
5839 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
5840 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
5841 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
5842 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
5843
5844 ** Comint (subshell) changes
5845
5846 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
5847 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
5848
5849 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
5850 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
5851 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
5852 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
5853 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
5854 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
5855
5856 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
5857 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
5858 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
5859 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
5860 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
5861 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
5862 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
5863 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
5864
5865 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
5866 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
5867
5868 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
5869 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
5870 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
5871
5872 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
5873 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
5874 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
5875
5876 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
5877 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
5878 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
5879
5880 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
5881 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
5882 argument, it appends to the file.
5883
5884 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
5885 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
5886 compatibility.
5887
5888 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
5889 ring (history).
5890
5891 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
5892 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
5893 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
5894
5895 ** Changes to Rmail mode
5896
5897 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
5898 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
5899 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
5900 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
5901 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
5902 as correspondent.
5903
5904 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
5905 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
5906 regexp matching your mail addresses.
5907
5908 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
5909 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
5910 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
5911 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
5912 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
5913
5914 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
5915 like `j'.
5916
5917 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
5918 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
5919 digest message.
5920
5921 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
5922 in which folder to put messages automatically.
5923
5924 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
5925 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
5926 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
5927
5928 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
5929 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
5930
5931 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
5932 use the -f option when sending mail.
5933
5934 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
5935 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
5936 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
5937 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
5938 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
5939 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
5940
5941 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
5942 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
5943 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
5944
5945 ** Changes to TeX mode
5946
5947 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
5948 `latex-mode'.
5949
5950 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
5951
5952 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
5953
5954 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
5955
5956 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
5957
5958 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
5959 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
5960 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
5961 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
5962 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
5963 can be edited from that buffer.
5964
5965 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
5966 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
5967 `A' to use all marked entries).
5968
5969 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
5970 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
5971
5972 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
5973 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
5974 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
5975 been cited.
5976
5977 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
5978 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
5979 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
5980 in column 1 are always made leaves.
5981
5982 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
5983 has the following new features:
5984
5985 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
5986 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
5987 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
5988 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
5989
5990 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
5991 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
5992 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
5993 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
5994 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
5995 defaults to 1.
5996
5997 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
5998 file names.
5999
6000 ** Ispell changes
6001
6002 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6003 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6004 spell-checks the current buffer.
6005
6006 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6007 added.
6008
6009 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6010 correction is made and re-checked.
6011
6012 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6013
6014 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6015 cases.
6016
6017 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6018 on syntax errors.
6019
6020 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6021 end of the buffer.
6022
6023 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6024
6025 ** Makefile mode changes
6026
6027 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6028
6029 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6030 Fontlock mode is active.
6031
6032 ** Isearch changes
6033
6034 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6035 so that searches can be resumed.
6036
6037 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6038 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6039 that started the search.
6040
6041 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6042 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6043
6044 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6045
6046 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6047 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6048 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6049 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6050 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6051 `secondary-selection'.
6052
6053 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6054 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6055 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6056 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6057 usual snappy response.
6058
6059 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6060 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6061 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6062 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
6063
6064 ** VC Changes
6065
6066 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6067 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6068 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6069 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6070 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
6071 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
6072 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6073 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6074 file is registered in that backend.
6075
6076 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
6077 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
6078 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
6079 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
6080 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
6081 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
6082
6083 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
6084 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
6085 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
6086 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
6087 where it doesn't make sense.)
6088
6089 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
6090 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
6091 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
6092
6093 *** General Changes
6094
6095 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
6096 checks are always done now.
6097
6098 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
6099 operations.
6100
6101 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
6102 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
6103 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
6104
6105 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
6106 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
6107 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
6108 the working file (``merge news'').
6109
6110 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6111 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
6112 downwards.
6113
6114 *** Multiple Backends
6115
6116 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
6117 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
6118 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
6119 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
6120 local RCS archives.
6121
6122 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
6123 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
6124 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
6125 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
6126
6127 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
6128 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
6129 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
6130 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
6131 current revision number from the more remote backend.
6132
6133 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
6134 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
6135 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
6136 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
6137
6138 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
6139 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
6140 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
6141 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
6142
6143 *** Changes for CVS
6144
6145 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
6146 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
6147 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
6148 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
6149 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
6150 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
6151 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
6152
6153 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
6154 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
6155 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
6156 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
6157 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
6158 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
6159 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
6160 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
6161 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
6162 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
6163 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
6164 name.)
6165
6166 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
6167 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
6168 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
6169 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
6170 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
6171 entire directory tree.
6172
6173 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
6174 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
6175 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
6176 "watched" by other developers.)
6177
6178 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6179 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
6180 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
6181 starting at the given directory.
6182
6183 *** Lisp Changes in VC
6184
6185 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
6186 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
6187 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
6188 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
6189 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
6190 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
6191 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
6192 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
6193 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
6194
6195 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
6196 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
6197 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
6198 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
6199
6200 ** New modes and packages
6201
6202 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
6203 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
6204 the default is not applicable.
6205
6206 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
6207 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
6208 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
6209
6210 Features are:
6211
6212 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
6213 drawn, like this: | \ /
6214 --+-- X
6215 | / \
6216
6217 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
6218 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
6219 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
6220 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
6221 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
6222 you are drawing.
6223
6224 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
6225 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
6226
6227 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
6228 flood-filling.
6229
6230 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
6231 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
6232 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
6233 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
6234
6235 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
6236 also do without the mouse.
6237
6238 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
6239 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
6240 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
6241 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
6242 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
6243
6244 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
6245
6246 lines straight-lines
6247 rectangles squares
6248 poly-lines straight poly-lines
6249 ellipses circles
6250 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
6251 spray-can setting size for spraying
6252 vaporize line vaporize lines
6253 erase characters erase rectangles
6254
6255 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
6256 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
6257 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
6258 drawing.
6259
6260 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
6261 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
6262 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
6263 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
6264
6265 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
6266 can be turned off).
6267
6268 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
6269 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
6270 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
6271 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
6272 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
6273 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
6274 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
6275 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
6276 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
6277
6278 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
6279 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
6280 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
6281 on certain projects.
6282
6283 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
6284 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
6285
6286 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
6287
6288 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
6289 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
6290 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
6291 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
6292 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
6293 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
6294 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
6295 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
6296
6297 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
6298 Emacs is idle.
6299
6300 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
6301 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
6302
6303 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
6304 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
6305
6306 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
6307 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
6308 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
6309 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
6310 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
6311
6312 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
6313 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
6314 separate Texinfo file.
6315
6316 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
6317 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
6318 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
6319 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
6320 enter check-in log messages.
6321
6322 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
6323 without invoking external programs.
6324
6325 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
6326 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
6327 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
6328 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
6329 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6330
6331 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
6332 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
6333
6334 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
6335 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
6336
6337 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
6338 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
6339 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
6340 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
6341 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
6342 single step.
6343
6344 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
6345 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
6346 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
6347 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
6348
6349 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
6350 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
6351 actually modifying content of a buffer.
6352
6353 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
6354 PostScript.
6355
6356 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
6357
6358 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
6359
6360 ; comment (until end of line)
6361 A non-terminal
6362 "C" terminal
6363 ?C? special
6364 $A default non-terminal
6365 $"C" default terminal
6366 $?C? default special
6367 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
6368 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
6369 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
6370 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
6371 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
6372 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
6373 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
6374 C+ one or more occurrences of C
6375 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
6376 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
6377 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
6378 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
6379 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
6380 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6381 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6382
6383 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
6384
6385 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
6386 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
6387 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
6388 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
6389 equal signs of assignments.
6390
6391 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
6392 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
6393
6394 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
6395 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
6396 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6397
6398 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
6399
6400 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
6401 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
6402 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
6403 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
6404 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
6405 which answers different needs.
6406
6407 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
6408 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
6409 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
6410 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
6411 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
6412 to be enabled.
6413
6414 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6415 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6416
6417 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
6418
6419 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
6420 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
6421 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
6422
6423 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
6424
6425 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
6426 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
6427 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
6428 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
6429 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
6430 and background colors.
6431
6432 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
6433 Pascal) language.
6434
6435 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
6436 the text at point.
6437
6438 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
6439
6440 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
6441
6442 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
6443 whitespace in a file.
6444
6445 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
6446 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
6447 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
6448 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
6449 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
6450 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
6451 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
6452
6453 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
6454
6455 Here is an example of columns:
6456
6457 horse apple bus
6458 dog pineapple car EXTRA
6459 porcupine strawberry airplane
6460
6461 Doing the following settings:
6462
6463 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
6464 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
6465 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
6466 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
6467
6468
6469 Selecting the lines above and typing:
6470
6471 M-x delimit-columns-region
6472
6473 It results:
6474
6475 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
6476 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
6477 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
6478
6479 delim-col has the following options:
6480
6481 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
6482 before all columns.
6483
6484 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
6485 between each column.
6486
6487 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
6488 after all columns.
6489
6490 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
6491 each column.
6492
6493 delim-col has the following commands:
6494
6495 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
6496 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
6497
6498 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
6499 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
6500 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
6501 recent file list can be displayed:
6502
6503 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
6504 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
6505 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
6506
6507 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
6508 dynamically change the menu appearance.
6509
6510 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
6511 text.
6512
6513 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
6514 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
6515 specific to Message mode.
6516
6517 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
6518 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
6519 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
6520
6521 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
6522 interface to access directory servers using different directory
6523 protocols. It has a separate manual.
6524
6525 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
6526 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
6527
6528 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
6529
6530 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
6531 minibuffer with completion.
6532
6533 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
6534 with the diary features.
6535
6536 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
6537 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
6538
6539 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
6540 Fill mode.
6541
6542 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
6543 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
6544 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
6545 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
6546
6547 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
6548 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
6549 `.g'.
6550
6551 ** Changes in sort.el
6552
6553 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
6554 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
6555 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
6556 numeric base.
6557
6558 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
6559
6560 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
6561 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
6562 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
6563
6564 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
6565 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
6566
6567 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
6568 output ^M at the end of lines.
6569
6570 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
6571 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
6572
6573 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
6574 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
6575 `(msb-mode 1)'.
6576
6577 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
6578 group.
6579
6580 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
6581 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
6582 are recognized:
6583
6584 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
6585 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
6586 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
6587 nil -- just delete one character.
6588
6589 Default value is `untabify'.
6590
6591 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
6592
6593 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
6594 symbol, not double-quoted.
6595
6596 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
6597 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
6598 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
6599 moved to lisp/obsolete.
6600
6601 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
6602 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
6603 `auto-compression-mode' command.
6604
6605 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
6606 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
6607 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
6608
6609 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
6610 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
6611
6612 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
6613 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
6614
6615 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
6616 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
6617
6618 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
6619 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
6620 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
6621 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
6622 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
6623 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
6624
6625 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
6626 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
6627
6628 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
6629
6630 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
6631 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
6632
6633 ** Shell script mode changes.
6634
6635 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
6636 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
6637 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
6638
6639 ** Etags changes.
6640
6641 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
6642
6643 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
6644 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
6645 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
6646 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
6647 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
6648
6649 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
6650 declarations when given the --declarations option.
6651
6652 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
6653 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
6654
6655 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
6656 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
6657 `template' keywords.
6658
6659 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
6660 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
6661
6662 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
6663 types.
6664
6665 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
6666
6667 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
6668
6669 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
6670 are now tagged.
6671
6672 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
6673
6674 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
6675 variables are tagged.
6676
6677 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
6678
6679 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
6680 for PSWrap.
6681
6682 ** Changes in etags.el
6683
6684 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
6685 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
6686 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
6687
6688 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
6689 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
6690
6691 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
6692 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
6693 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
6694 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
6695
6696 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
6697
6698 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
6699 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
6700
6701 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
6702
6703 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
6704 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
6705 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
6706
6707 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
6708 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
6709
6710 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
6711 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
6712
6713 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
6714 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
6715 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
6716 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
6717 point will go to the beginning of the file.
6718
6719 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
6720 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
6721 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
6722
6723 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
6724 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
6725 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
6726
6727 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
6728 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
6729 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
6730
6731 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
6732
6733 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
6734
6735 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
6736 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
6737 expression from that list, are not checked.
6738
6739 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
6740 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
6741 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
6742 the buffer, just like for the local files.
6743
6744 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
6745
6746 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
6747 displays local abbrevs, only.
6748
6749 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
6750 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
6751
6752 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
6753 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
6754 is measured in pixels.
6755
6756 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
6757 to be visited as images.
6758
6759 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
6760 were added to compile.el.
6761
6762 ** Withdrawn packages
6763
6764 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
6765 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
6766
6767 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
6768
6769 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
6770
6771 \f
6772 * Incompatible Lisp changes
6773
6774 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
6775 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
6776 See the sections below for details.
6777
6778 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
6779 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
6780 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
6781 to remove the properties of the copy.
6782
6783 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
6784 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
6785 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
6786 these properties are active.
6787
6788 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
6789 ranges may affect some code.
6790
6791 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
6792 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
6793 make a difference to some code.
6794
6795 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
6796 operates on the minibuffer.
6797
6798 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
6799 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
6800 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
6801 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
6802 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
6803 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
6804 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
6805 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
6806 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
6807 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
6808 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
6809 the buffer as multibyte characters.
6810
6811 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
6812 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
6813 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
6814
6815 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
6816 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
6817 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
6818
6819 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
6820 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
6821 such as `mapconcat'.
6822
6823 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
6824 string.
6825
6826 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
6827 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
6828 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
6829 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
6830 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
6831 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
6832 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
6833 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
6834
6835 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
6836 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
6837 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
6838 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
6839 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
6840 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
6841 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
6842 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
6843 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
6844 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
6845
6846 \f
6847 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
6848 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
6849
6850 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
6851
6852 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
6853 allows the animated display of strings.
6854
6855 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
6856 interactive form of a function.
6857
6858 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
6859 between custom options. Example:
6860
6861 (defcustom default-input-method nil
6862 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
6863 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
6864 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
6865 :group 'mule
6866 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
6867 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
6868
6869 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
6870 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
6871 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
6872
6873 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
6874 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
6875 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
6876 (signal or normal termination).
6877
6878 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
6879 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
6880
6881 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
6882 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
6883
6884 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
6885 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
6886
6887 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
6888
6889 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
6890 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
6891 being deleted.
6892
6893 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
6894
6895 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
6896 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
6897 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
6898 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
6899 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
6900 charset.
6901
6902 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
6903 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
6904 message.
6905
6906 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
6907 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
6908
6909 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
6910 with the more general `:mask' property.
6911
6912 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
6913
6914 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
6915 backslash.
6916
6917 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
6918 is running in batch mode. For example,
6919
6920 (message "%s" (read t))
6921
6922 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
6923 to standard output.
6924
6925 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
6926 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
6927
6928 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
6929 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
6930 frame or window.
6931
6932 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
6933 were added
6934
6935 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
6936
6937 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
6938 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
6939
6940 - Function: remq ELT LIST
6941
6942 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
6943 comparison is done with `eq'.
6944
6945 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
6946
6947 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
6948 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
6949 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
6950
6951 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
6952 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
6953 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
6954
6955 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
6956 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
6957
6958 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
6959 function was declared obsolete.
6960
6961 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
6962 retained as an alias).
6963
6964 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
6965 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
6966
6967 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
6968
6969 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
6970
6971 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
6972 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
6973 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
6974 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
6975 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
6976 means never include the minibuffer window.
6977
6978 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
6979
6980 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
6981
6982 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
6983
6984 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
6985 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
6986 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
6987 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
6988 returned.
6989
6990 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
6991 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
6992 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
6993 minibuffer even if it is active.
6994
6995 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
6996 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
6997 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
6998 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
6999 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7000 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7001
7002 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7003 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7004 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7005 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7006 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7007 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7008 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7009
7010 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7011 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7012 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7013
7014 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7015 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7016 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7017 Default value is nil.
7018
7019 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7020 meaning no limit.
7021
7022 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7023 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7024 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7025
7026 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7027 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7028 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7029
7030 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7031 list of a primitive.
7032
7033 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7034
7035 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7036 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7037 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7038 than replacing the local map.
7039
7040 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7041 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7042 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7043 instead.
7044
7045 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7046
7047 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7048 as promised long ago.
7049
7050 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7051
7052 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7053 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7054 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7055
7056 \f
7057 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7058
7059 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7060 regular expressions.
7061
7062 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7063
7064 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7065
7066 - Macro: rx SEXP
7067
7068 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7069
7070 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7071 notation.
7072
7073 STRING
7074 matches string STRING literally.
7075
7076 CHAR
7077 matches character CHAR literally.
7078
7079 `not-newline'
7080 matches any character except a newline.
7081 .
7082 `anything'
7083 matches any character
7084
7085 `(any SET)'
7086 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
7087 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
7088
7089 '(in SET)'
7090 like `any'.
7091
7092 `(not (any SET))'
7093 matches any character not in SET
7094
7095 `line-start'
7096 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
7097 in the text being matched
7098
7099 `line-end'
7100 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
7101
7102 `string-start'
7103 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7104 string being matched against.
7105
7106 `string-end'
7107 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7108 string being matched against.
7109
7110 `buffer-start'
7111 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7112 buffer being matched against.
7113
7114 `buffer-end'
7115 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7116 buffer being matched against.
7117
7118 `point'
7119 matches the empty string, but only at point.
7120
7121 `word-start'
7122 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7123 word.
7124
7125 `word-end'
7126 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
7127
7128 `word-boundary'
7129 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7130 word.
7131
7132 `(not word-boundary)'
7133 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
7134 word.
7135
7136 `digit'
7137 matches 0 through 9.
7138
7139 `control'
7140 matches ASCII control characters.
7141
7142 `hex-digit'
7143 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7144
7145 `blank'
7146 matches space and tab only.
7147
7148 `graphic'
7149 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7150 space, and DEL.
7151
7152 `printing'
7153 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7154 and DEL.
7155
7156 `alphanumeric'
7157 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7158 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7159
7160 `letter'
7161 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7162 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7163
7164 `ascii'
7165 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7166
7167 `nonascii'
7168 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7169
7170 `lower'
7171 matches anything lower-case.
7172
7173 `upper'
7174 matches anything upper-case.
7175
7176 `punctuation'
7177 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7178 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7179
7180 `space'
7181 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7182
7183 `word'
7184 matches anything that has word syntax.
7185
7186 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
7187 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
7188 of the following symbols.
7189
7190 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
7191 `punctuation' (\\s.)
7192 `word' (\\sw)
7193 `symbol' (\\s_)
7194 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
7195 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
7196 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
7197 `string-quote' (\\s\")
7198 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
7199 `escape' (\\s\\)
7200 `character-quote' (\\s/)
7201 `comment-start' (\\s<)
7202 `comment-end' (\\s>)
7203
7204 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
7205 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
7206
7207 `(category CATEGORY)'
7208 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
7209 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
7210
7211 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
7212 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
7213 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
7214 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
7215 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
7216 `symbol' (\\c5)
7217 `digit' (\\c6)
7218 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
7219 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
7220 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
7221 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
7222 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
7223 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
7224 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
7225 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
7226 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
7227 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
7228 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
7229 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
7230 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
7231 `ascii' (\\ca)
7232 `arabic' (\\cb)
7233 `chinese' (\\cc)
7234 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
7235 `greek' (\\cg)
7236 `korean' (\\ch)
7237 `indian' (\\ci)
7238 `japanese' (\\cj)
7239 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
7240 `latin' (\\cl)
7241 `lao' (\\co)
7242 `tibetan' (\\cq)
7243 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
7244 `thai' (\\ct)
7245 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
7246 `hebrew' (\\cw)
7247 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
7248 `can-break' (\\c|)
7249
7250 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
7251 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
7252
7253 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7254 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
7255
7256 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7257 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
7258 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
7259
7260 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7261 another name for `submatch'.
7262
7263 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7264 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
7265 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
7266 regular expression.
7267
7268 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
7269 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
7270 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
7271 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
7272 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
7273
7274 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
7275 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
7276
7277 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
7278 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7279
7280 `(0+ SEXP)'
7281 like `zero-or-more'.
7282
7283 `(* SEXP)'
7284 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7285
7286 `(*? SEXP)'
7287 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7288
7289 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
7290 matches one or more occurrences of A.
7291
7292 `(1+ SEXP)'
7293 like `one-or-more'.
7294
7295 `(+ SEXP)'
7296 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7297
7298 `(+? SEXP)'
7299 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7300
7301 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
7302 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
7303
7304 `(optional SEXP)'
7305 like `zero-or-one'.
7306
7307 `(? SEXP)'
7308 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7309
7310 `(?? SEXP)'
7311 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7312
7313 `(repeat N SEXP)'
7314 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7315
7316 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
7317 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7318
7319 `(eval FORM)'
7320 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
7321 `regexp-quote' it.
7322
7323 `(regexp REGEXP)'
7324 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
7325
7326 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
7327
7328 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
7329 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
7330 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
7331 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
7332
7333 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
7334 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
7335 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
7336 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
7337
7338 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
7339 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
7340 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
7341
7342 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
7343 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
7344 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
7345 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
7346 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
7347 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
7348 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
7349 eight-bit-graphic.
7350
7351 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
7352
7353 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
7354 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
7355 character set as previously.
7356
7357 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
7358 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
7359 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
7360
7361 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
7362 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
7363 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
7364 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
7365
7366 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
7367 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
7368
7369 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
7370 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
7371 "fontset-default".
7372
7373 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
7374 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
7375
7376 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
7377 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
7378 buffers and strings.
7379
7380 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
7381 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
7382 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
7383 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
7384 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
7385 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
7386 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
7387 also been deleted.
7388
7389 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
7390 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
7391 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
7392
7393 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
7394 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
7395 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
7396 may differ between buffer and string text.
7397
7398 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
7399 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
7400
7401 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
7402 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
7403 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
7404 `composition' from STRING.
7405
7406 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
7407 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
7408
7409 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
7410 obsolete.
7411
7412 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
7413 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
7414
7415 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
7416 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
7417 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
7418 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
7419
7420 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
7421 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
7422 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
7423 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
7424 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
7425 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
7426
7427 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
7428 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
7429 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
7430
7431 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
7432 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
7433 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
7434
7435 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
7436 have been introduced.
7437
7438 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7439 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
7440 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
7441 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
7442 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
7443 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
7444 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
7445 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
7446 their multibyte equivalent.
7447
7448 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
7449 that offset in the file before writing.
7450
7451 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
7452 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
7453
7454 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
7455 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
7456 from which the command was issued.
7457
7458 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
7459 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
7460 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
7461 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
7462 operate on.
7463
7464 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
7465 to `window-buffer-height'.
7466
7467 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
7468
7469 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
7470 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
7471 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
7472
7473 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
7474 respectively.
7475
7476 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
7477 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
7478
7479 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
7480 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
7481 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
7482
7483 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
7484 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
7485 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
7486 is currently displayed in some window.
7487
7488 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
7489 argument function's results.
7490
7491 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
7492 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
7493 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
7494 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
7495 sequence).
7496
7497 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
7498 header in the list of headers passed to it.
7499
7500 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
7501 ignores differences in case and text representation.
7502
7503 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
7504 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
7505 as follows:
7506
7507 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
7508 nil don't display a cursor
7509 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
7510 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
7511 others display a box cursor.
7512
7513 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
7514 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
7515 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
7516 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
7517
7518 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
7519 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
7520 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
7521 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
7522
7523 Example:
7524
7525 (string-to-syntax "()")
7526 => (4 . 41)
7527
7528 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
7529 other than 10.
7530
7531 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
7532 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
7533
7534 #b1111
7535 => 15
7536 #b-1111
7537 => -15
7538
7539 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
7540
7541 #o666
7542 => 438
7543
7544 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
7545
7546 #xbeef
7547 => 48815
7548
7549 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
7550
7551 #2R-111
7552 => -7
7553 #25rah
7554 => 267
7555
7556 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
7557 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
7558 and isn't a string.
7559
7560 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
7561 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
7562 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
7563 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
7564
7565 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
7566
7567 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
7568 for a regexp in a string.
7569
7570 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
7571 `mouse-position-function'.
7572
7573 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
7574 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
7575
7576 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
7577 Keywords are now always considered constants.
7578
7579 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
7580 returns it.
7581
7582 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
7583 returned by function `recent-keys'.
7584
7585 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
7586 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
7587 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
7588 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
7589 mode.
7590
7591 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
7592 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
7593
7594 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
7595 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
7596 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
7597 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
7598 been performed."
7599
7600 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
7601 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
7602 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
7603 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
7604
7605 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
7606 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
7607 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
7608
7609 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
7610 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
7611 specified table.
7612
7613 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
7614
7615 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
7616 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
7617 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
7618 what BODY returns.
7619
7620 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
7621 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
7622 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
7623 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
7624 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
7625
7626 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
7627 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
7628
7629 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
7630 instead of being optional.
7631
7632 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
7633 modify read-only text.
7634
7635 ** New functions and variables for locales.
7636
7637 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
7638 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
7639 time functions like strftime. The new variables
7640 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
7641 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
7642
7643 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
7644 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
7645 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
7646 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
7647 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
7648 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
7649 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
7650
7651 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
7652 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
7653 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
7654 start sequences.
7655
7656 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
7657 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
7658
7659 ** New function `propertize'
7660
7661 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
7662 strings with text properties.
7663
7664 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
7665
7666 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
7667 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
7668 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
7669 specified value of that property. Example:
7670
7671 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
7672
7673 ** push and pop macros.
7674
7675 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
7676 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
7677 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
7678
7679 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
7680 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
7681 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
7682
7683 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
7684
7685 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
7686 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
7687
7688 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
7689 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
7690 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
7691 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7692
7693 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
7694 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
7695 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
7696 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7697
7698 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
7699 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
7700 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
7701 or a sign.
7702
7703 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
7704 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
7705 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7706 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
7707 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7708 space, and DEL.
7709 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7710 and DEL.
7711 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
7712 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7713 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7714 [:alpha:] matches letters.
7715 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7716 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7717 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7718 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7719 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
7720 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
7721 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7722 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7723 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7724 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
7725 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
7726
7727 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
7728
7729 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
7730
7731 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
7732
7733 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
7734 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
7735
7736 :test TEST
7737
7738 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
7739 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
7740 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
7741
7742 :size SIZE
7743
7744 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
7745 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
7746
7747 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
7748
7749 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
7750 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
7751 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
7752 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
7753 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
7754
7755 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
7756
7757 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
7758 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
7759 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
7760
7761 :weakness WEAK
7762
7763 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
7764 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
7765 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
7766 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
7767 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
7768
7769 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
7770
7771 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
7772
7773 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
7774
7775 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
7776
7777 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
7778
7779 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
7780 values are shared.
7781
7782 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
7783
7784 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
7785
7786 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7787
7788 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
7789
7790 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
7791
7792 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
7793
7794 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7795
7796 Returns the size of TABLE.
7797
7798 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
7799
7800 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
7801
7802 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
7803
7804 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
7805
7806 - Function: clrhash TABLE
7807
7808 Clear TABLE.
7809
7810 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
7811
7812 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
7813 not found.
7814
7815 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
7816
7817 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
7818 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
7819
7820 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
7821
7822 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
7823
7824 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
7825
7826 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
7827 arguments KEY and VALUE.
7828
7829 - Function: sxhash OBJ
7830
7831 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
7832
7833 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
7834
7835 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
7836 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
7837 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
7838 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
7839 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
7840
7841 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
7842
7843 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
7844 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
7845 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
7846
7847 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
7848 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
7849
7850 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
7851 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
7852
7853 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
7854 (sxhash (upcase a)))
7855
7856 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
7857 'case-fold-string-hash))
7858
7859 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
7860
7861 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
7862
7863 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
7864 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
7865 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
7866
7867 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
7868
7869 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
7870 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
7871
7872 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
7873 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
7874 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
7875 is too short to reach that column.
7876
7877 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
7878 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
7879 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
7880 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
7881
7882 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
7883 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
7884 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
7885
7886 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
7887 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
7888
7889 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
7890 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
7891
7892 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
7893 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
7894 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
7895 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
7896 temporary-file-directory instead.
7897
7898 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
7899 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
7900 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
7901 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
7902
7903 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
7904 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
7905
7906 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
7907
7908 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
7909 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
7910 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
7911
7912 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
7913
7914 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
7915 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
7916 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
7917 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
7918 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
7919 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
7920
7921 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
7922 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
7923 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
7924 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
7925
7926 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
7927
7928 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
7929 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
7930 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
7931 result string.
7932
7933 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
7934 string where arguments appear in the result string.
7935
7936 Example:
7937
7938 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
7939 (s2 "world"))
7940 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
7941 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
7942 (format s1 s2))
7943
7944 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
7945
7946 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
7947
7948 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
7949 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
7950 argument in it.
7951
7952 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
7953 (arg "world"))
7954 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
7955 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
7956 (message msg arg))
7957
7958 ** Sound support
7959
7960 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
7961 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
7962
7963 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
7964 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
7965 to enable sound support.
7966
7967 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
7968 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
7969 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
7970 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
7971 sound to play, before playing the sound.
7972
7973 The following sound properties are supported:
7974
7975 - `:file FILE'
7976
7977 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
7978 searched relative to `data-directory'.
7979
7980 - `:data DATA'
7981
7982 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
7983 may be present, but not both.
7984
7985 - `:volume VOLUME'
7986
7987 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
7988 0..1. This property is optional.
7989
7990 - `:device DEVICE'
7991
7992 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
7993 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
7994
7995 Other properties are ignored.
7996
7997 An alternative interface is called as
7998 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
7999
8000 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8001
8002 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8003 a keyword symbol.
8004
8005 ** Changes to garbage collection
8006
8007 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8008 of live and free strings.
8009
8010 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8011 strings that have been consed so far.
8012
8013 \f
8014 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8015 Lisp Manual
8016
8017 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8018 mini-windows.
8019
8020 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8021 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8022 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8023
8024 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8025
8026 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8027
8028 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8029 image.
8030
8031 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8032
8033 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8034
8035 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8036 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8037 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8038 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8039 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8040
8041 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8042 has a mask bitmap.
8043
8044 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8045
8046 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8047 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8048 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8049
8050 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8051 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8052
8053 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8054 optional.
8055
8056 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8057 below).
8058
8059 \f
8060 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8061
8062 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8063 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8064
8065 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8066 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8067 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8068 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8069 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8070 just display it black instead.
8071
8072 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8073 a line like
8074
8075 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
8076
8077 in your `.emacs'.
8078
8079 ** New face implementation.
8080
8081 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
8082 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
8083
8084 *** New faces.
8085
8086 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
8087
8088 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
8089
8090 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
8091 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
8092
8093 3. Font height in 1/10pt
8094
8095 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
8096
8097 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
8098
8099 6. Foreground color.
8100
8101 7. Background color.
8102
8103 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
8104
8105 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
8106
8107 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
8108
8109 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
8110
8111 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
8112 color.
8113
8114 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
8115 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
8116
8117 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
8118 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
8119 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
8120 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
8121 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
8122 attributes mentioned above.
8123
8124 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
8125 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
8126 created frames.
8127
8128 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
8129 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
8130 `fully-specified'.
8131
8132 *** Face merging.
8133
8134 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
8135 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
8136 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
8137 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
8138 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
8139 results in a fully-specified face.
8140
8141 *** Face realization.
8142
8143 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
8144 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
8145 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
8146 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
8147 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
8148 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
8149
8150 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
8151 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
8152 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
8153 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
8154
8155 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
8156 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
8157 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
8158 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
8159 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
8160
8161 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
8162 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
8163 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
8164 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
8165 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
8166 Emacs.
8167
8168 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
8169 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
8170 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
8171 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
8172
8173 **** Clearing face caches.
8174
8175 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
8176 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
8177 unused fonts.
8178
8179 *** Font selection.
8180
8181 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
8182 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
8183 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
8184
8185 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
8186 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
8187 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
8188 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
8189 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
8190
8191 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
8192 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
8193 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
8194
8195 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
8196
8197 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
8198 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
8199 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
8200 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
8201 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
8202 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
8203 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
8204
8205 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8206 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
8207 doesn't exist.
8208
8209 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8210 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
8211 registry.
8212
8213 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
8214 slightly different.
8215
8216 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
8217
8218
8219 **** Scalable fonts
8220
8221 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
8222 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
8223 servers.
8224
8225 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
8226 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
8227 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
8228 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
8229 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
8230 that list. Example:
8231
8232 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
8233
8234 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
8235
8236 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
8237
8238 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
8239
8240 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
8241 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
8242 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
8243
8244 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
8245 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
8246 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
8247 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
8248 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
8249 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
8250 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
8251 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
8252 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
8253 of the face font sort order.
8254
8255 - Function: x-font-family-list
8256
8257 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
8258 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
8259 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
8260 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
8261
8262 - Variable: font-list-limit
8263
8264 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
8265 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
8266 matching font. The default is currently 100.
8267
8268 *** Setting face attributes.
8269
8270 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
8271 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
8272 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
8273 `face-attribute'.
8274
8275 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
8276 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
8277
8278 The following attributes are recognized:
8279
8280 `:family'
8281
8282 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
8283 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
8284 and `?' are allowed.
8285
8286 `:width'
8287
8288 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
8289 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
8290 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
8291 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
8292
8293 `:height'
8294
8295 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
8296 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
8297 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
8298 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
8299
8300 `:weight'
8301
8302 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
8303 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
8304 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
8305
8306 `:slant'
8307
8308 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
8309 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
8310 `reverse-oblique'.
8311
8312 `:foreground', `:background'
8313
8314 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
8315
8316 `:underline'
8317
8318 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
8319 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
8320 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
8321 don't underline.
8322
8323 `:overline'
8324
8325 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
8326 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
8327 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
8328 overline.
8329
8330 `:strike-through'
8331
8332 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
8333 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
8334 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
8335 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
8336
8337 `:box'
8338
8339 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
8340 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
8341 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
8342 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
8343 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
8344 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
8345 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
8346 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
8347 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
8348 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
8349 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
8350 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
8351 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
8352 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
8353 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
8354 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
8355 box.
8356
8357 `:inverse-video'
8358
8359 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
8360 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
8361
8362 `:stipple'
8363
8364 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
8365 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
8366 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
8367 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
8368 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
8369 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
8370
8371 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
8372 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
8373
8374 `:font'
8375
8376 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
8377 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
8378 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
8379 versions of Emacs.
8380
8381 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
8382 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
8383 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
8384
8385 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
8386 `defface'.
8387
8388 `:inherit'
8389
8390 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
8391 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
8392 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
8393
8394 *** Face attributes and X resources
8395
8396 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
8397 from X resources:
8398
8399 Face attribute X resource class
8400 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
8401 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
8402 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
8403 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
8404 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
8405 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
8406 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
8407 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
8408 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
8409 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
8410 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
8411 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
8412 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
8413 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
8414 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
8415 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
8416 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8417 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
8418 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
8419 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8420
8421 *** Text property `face'.
8422
8423 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
8424 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
8425 specification can be
8426
8427 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
8428
8429 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
8430 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
8431 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
8432 for face attribute names.
8433
8434 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
8435 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
8436 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
8437
8438 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
8439
8440 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
8441 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
8442 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
8443 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
8444 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
8445 used to clear the mapping table.
8446
8447 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
8448
8449 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
8450 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
8451 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
8452 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
8453 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
8454 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
8455 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
8456 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
8457 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
8458 modify their color-related behavior.
8459
8460 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
8461 any frame type.
8462
8463 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
8464
8465 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
8466 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
8467 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
8468 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
8469 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
8470 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
8471 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
8472 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
8473 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
8474
8475 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
8476 display can display image files.
8477
8478 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
8479
8480 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
8481 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
8482 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
8483 `Inviolable' option.
8484
8485 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
8486 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
8487 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
8488
8489 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
8490
8491 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
8492 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
8493 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
8494
8495 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
8496 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
8497 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
8498 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
8499 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
8500 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
8501 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
8502 functions.
8503
8504 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
8505 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
8506 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
8507
8508 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
8509
8510 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
8511
8512 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
8513
8514 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8515 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
8516 constrained position if that is different.
8517
8518 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
8519 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
8520 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
8521 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
8522 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8523 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
8524 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
8525 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
8526 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
8527
8528 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
8529 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
8530 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
8531 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
8532 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
8533
8534 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
8535 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
8536
8537 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
8538
8539 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
8540
8541 Delete the field surrounding POS.
8542 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8543 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8544
8545 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8546
8547 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
8548 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8549 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8550 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
8551 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
8552
8553 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8554
8555 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
8556 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8557 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8558 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
8559 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
8560
8561 - Function: field-string &optional POS
8562
8563 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
8564 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8565 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8566
8567 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
8568
8569 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
8570 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8571 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8572
8573 ** Image support.
8574
8575 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
8576 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
8577 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
8578 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
8579
8580 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
8581 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
8582 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
8583 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
8584 area.
8585
8586 IMAGE is an image specification.
8587
8588 *** Image specifications
8589
8590 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
8591 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
8592 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
8593 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
8594 described below are ignored.
8595
8596 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
8597
8598 `:ascent ASCENT'
8599
8600 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
8601 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
8602 to use for its ascent.
8603
8604 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
8605 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
8606
8607 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
8608 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
8609 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
8610 overlays that apply to the image.
8611
8612 `:margin MARGIN'
8613
8614 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
8615 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
8616 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
8617
8618 `:relief RELIEF'
8619
8620 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
8621 around an image.
8622
8623 `:conversion ALGO'
8624
8625 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
8626
8627 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
8628 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
8629
8630 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
8631 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
8632 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
8633 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
8634 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
8635 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
8636 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
8637 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
8638 below.
8639
8640 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
8641 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
8642 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
8643
8644 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
8645 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
8646 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
8647 of the factors' absolute values.
8648
8649 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
8650
8651 (1 0 0
8652 0 0 0
8653 9 9 -1)
8654
8655 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
8656
8657 ( 2 -1 0
8658 -1 0 1
8659 0 1 -2)
8660
8661 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
8662 ``disabled''.
8663
8664 `:mask MASK'
8665
8666 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
8667 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
8668 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
8669 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
8670 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
8671 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
8672 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
8673 image.
8674
8675 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
8676 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
8677 `:mask nil'.
8678
8679 `:file FILE'
8680
8681 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
8682 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
8683 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
8684 may be present in the image specification.
8685
8686 `:data DATA'
8687
8688 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
8689 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
8690 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
8691 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
8692
8693 *** Supported image types
8694
8695 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
8696
8697 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
8698 properties supported are:
8699
8700 `:foreground FG'
8701
8702 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
8703 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
8704
8705 `:background BG'
8706
8707 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
8708 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
8709
8710 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
8711 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
8712 instead of a `:file' property.
8713
8714 `:width WIDTH'
8715
8716 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
8717
8718 `:height HEIGHT'
8719
8720 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
8721
8722 `:data DATA'
8723
8724 DATA must be either
8725
8726 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
8727 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
8728
8729 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
8730
8731 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
8732 bitmap.
8733
8734 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
8735 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
8736 in the file.
8737
8738 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
8739
8740 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
8741 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
8742 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
8743 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
8744
8745 Additional image properties supported are:
8746
8747 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
8748
8749 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
8750 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
8751 name.
8752
8753 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
8754 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
8755
8756 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
8757 to display compressed images.
8758
8759 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
8760
8761 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
8762 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
8763 mono images are:
8764
8765 `:foreground FG'
8766
8767 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
8768 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
8769
8770 `:background FG'
8771
8772 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
8773 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
8774
8775 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
8776
8777 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
8778 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8779 properties defined.
8780
8781 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
8782
8783 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
8784 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8785 properties defined.
8786
8787 **** GIF, image type `gif'
8788
8789 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
8790 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
8791
8792 Additional image properties supported are:
8793
8794 `:index INDEX'
8795
8796 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
8797 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
8798 as a hollow box.
8799
8800 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
8801 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
8802 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
8803 every 0.1 seconds.
8804
8805 (defun show-anim (file max)
8806 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
8807 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
8808
8809 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
8810 (when (= idx max)
8811 (setq idx 0))
8812 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
8813 (save-excursion
8814 (set-buffer buffer)
8815 (goto-char (point-min))
8816 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
8817 (insert-image img "x"))
8818 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
8819
8820 **** PNG, image type `png'
8821
8822 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
8823 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8824 properties defined.
8825
8826 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
8827
8828 Additional image properties supported are:
8829
8830 `:pt-width WIDTH'
8831
8832 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
8833 integer. This is a required property.
8834
8835 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
8836
8837 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
8838 must be a integer. This is an required property.
8839
8840 `:bounding-box BOX'
8841
8842 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
8843 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
8844 files. This is an required property.
8845
8846 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
8847 lisp/gs.el.
8848
8849 *** Lisp interface.
8850
8851 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
8852 which are supported in the current configuration.
8853
8854 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
8855 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
8856 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
8857 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
8858 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
8859
8860 *** Simplified image API, image.el
8861
8862 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
8863 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
8864 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
8865 define an image based on available image types. The functions
8866 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
8867 buffer.
8868
8869 ** Display margins.
8870
8871 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
8872 and images.
8873
8874 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
8875 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
8876 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
8877 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
8878 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
8879 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
8880 of the display margins.
8881
8882 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
8883 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
8884 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
8885 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
8886 in this file).
8887
8888 ** Help display
8889
8890 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
8891 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
8892 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
8893 that have a `help-echo' property.
8894
8895 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
8896 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
8897 the window in which the help was found.
8898
8899 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
8900 `help-echo' text property was found.
8901
8902 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
8903 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
8904
8905 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
8906 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
8907 mouse.
8908
8909 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
8910 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
8911
8912 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
8913 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
8914 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
8915 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
8916 used as help string.
8917
8918 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
8919 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
8920 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
8921
8922 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
8923
8924 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
8925 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
8926
8927 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
8928 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
8929 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
8930 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
8931 used.
8932
8933 (global-set-key [A-down]
8934 #'(lambda ()
8935 (interactive)
8936 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
8937 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
8938 (global-set-key [A-up]
8939 #'(lambda ()
8940 (interactive)
8941 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
8942 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
8943
8944 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
8945
8946 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
8947 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
8948 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
8949 is called with one argument, POS.
8950
8951 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
8952 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
8953 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
8954 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
8955 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
8956
8957 ** Tool bar support.
8958
8959 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
8960 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
8961 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
8962 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
8963 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
8964 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
8965
8966 *** Tool bar item definitions
8967
8968 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
8969 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
8970 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
8971
8972 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
8973 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
8974 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
8975 property (see below).
8976
8977 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
8978 binding are currently ignored.
8979
8980 The following properties are recognized:
8981
8982 `:enable FORM'.
8983
8984 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
8985 or disabled.
8986
8987 `:visible FORM'
8988
8989 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
8990
8991 `:filter FUNCTION'
8992
8993 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
8994 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
8995 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
8996
8997 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
8998
8999 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9000 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9001
9002 `:image IMAGES'
9003
9004 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9005 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9006 meaning of each of the four elements:
9007
9008 Index Use when item is
9009 ----------------------------------------
9010 0 enabled and selected
9011 1 enabled and deselected
9012 2 disabled and selected
9013 3 disabled and deselected
9014
9015 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9016 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9017
9018 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9019
9020 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9021 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9022
9023 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9024 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9025 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9026 menu bar.
9027
9028 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9029 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9030 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9031
9032 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9033
9034 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9035 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9036 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9037
9038 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9039 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9040
9041 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9042 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9043 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9044 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9045
9046 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9047 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9048
9049 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9050
9051 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9052 a tool bar item. If
9053
9054 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9055 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9056 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9057
9058 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9059
9060 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9061
9062 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9063 item.
9064
9065 ** Mode line changes.
9066
9067 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9068
9069 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9070 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9071 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9072
9073 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9074 a `local-map' text property.
9075
9076 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
9077 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
9078
9079 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
9080 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
9081 `local-map' property.
9082
9083 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
9084 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
9085 example.
9086
9087 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
9088 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
9089
9090 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
9091 variable mode-line-format to nil.
9092
9093 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
9094
9095 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
9096 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
9097 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
9098 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
9099 line.
9100
9101 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
9102 `header-line'.
9103
9104 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
9105 position in the header-line.
9106
9107 ** Text property `display'
9108
9109 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
9110 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
9111 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
9112 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
9113 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
9114
9115 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
9116
9117 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
9118 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
9119
9120 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
9121 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
9122 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
9123 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9124 simpler form STRING as property value.
9125
9126 *** Variable width and height spaces
9127
9128 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
9129 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
9130 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
9131 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
9132 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
9133 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9134 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
9135
9136 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
9137 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
9138 properties described below.
9139
9140 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
9141 characters having the `display' property.
9142
9143 - :width WIDTH
9144
9145 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
9146 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
9147
9148 - :relative-width FACTOR
9149
9150 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
9151 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
9152 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
9153 width of that character by FACTOR.
9154
9155 - :align-to HPOS
9156
9157 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
9158 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
9159
9160 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
9161
9162 - :height HEIGHT
9163
9164 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
9165 normal line height.
9166
9167 - :relative-height FACTOR
9168
9169 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
9170 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
9171
9172 - :ascent ASCENT
9173
9174 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
9175 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
9176 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
9177 equal to 100.
9178
9179 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
9180
9181 *** Images
9182
9183 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
9184 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
9185 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
9186 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
9187 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
9188 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
9189 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
9190 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
9191 as display specification.
9192
9193 *** Other display properties
9194
9195 - (space-width FACTOR)
9196
9197 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
9198 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
9199 integer or float.
9200
9201 - (height HEIGHT)
9202
9203 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
9204
9205 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
9206 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
9207 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
9208 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
9209 a font is available counts as a step.
9210
9211 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
9212 as tall as the frame's default font.
9213
9214 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
9215 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
9216
9217 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
9218 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
9219
9220 - (raise FACTOR)
9221
9222 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
9223 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
9224 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
9225 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
9226 `height' subproperty.
9227
9228 *** Conditional display properties
9229
9230 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
9231 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
9232 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
9233 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
9234 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
9235 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
9236 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
9237 different when object is a string.
9238
9239 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
9240 `(when t . SPEC)'.
9241
9242 ** New menu separator types.
9243
9244 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
9245 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
9246 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
9247 to specify other menu separator types.
9248
9249 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
9250
9251 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
9252 separator occurs.
9253
9254 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
9255
9256 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
9257
9258 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
9259
9260 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
9261
9262 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
9263
9264 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9265
9266 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
9267
9268 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9269
9270 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
9271
9272 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
9273 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
9274
9275 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
9276
9277 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
9278
9279 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
9280
9281 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
9282
9283 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
9284
9285 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
9286
9287 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
9288
9289 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9290
9291 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
9292
9293 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
9294
9295 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
9296
9297 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9298
9299 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
9300
9301 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
9302
9303 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
9304 the corresponding single-line separators.
9305
9306 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
9307
9308 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
9309 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
9310 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
9311 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
9312 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
9313 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
9314 default foreground is black.
9315
9316 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
9317 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
9318 `ScrollBarBackground').
9319
9320 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
9321 settings for scroll bar colors.
9322
9323 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
9324 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
9325
9326 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
9327 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
9328 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
9329 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
9330 the original window start.
9331
9332 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
9333 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
9334 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
9335
9336 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
9337
9338 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
9339 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
9340 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
9341 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
9342
9343 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
9344 fixed-width and fixed-height.
9345
9346 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
9347
9348 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
9349 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
9350 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
9351 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
9352 temporarily to nil, for example
9353
9354 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
9355 (enlarge-window 10))
9356
9357 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
9358 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
9359
9360 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
9361 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
9362 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
9363 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
9364 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
9365 support a vertical-bar cursor).
9366
9367
9368 \f
9369 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
9370
9371 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
9372 input.
9373
9374 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
9375
9376 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
9377
9378 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
9379 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
9380 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
9381 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
9382 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
9383
9384 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
9385 been added.
9386
9387 \f
9388 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
9389
9390 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
9391
9392
9393 \f
9394 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
9395
9396 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
9397 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
9398 \f
9399 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
9400
9401 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
9402
9403 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
9404 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
9405 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
9406
9407 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
9408 is the one that is used.
9409
9410 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
9411 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
9412 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
9413 separate from the command's regular output.
9414 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
9415 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
9416 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
9417 the buffer name.
9418
9419 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
9420 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
9421 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
9422 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
9423
9424 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
9425 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
9426 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
9427 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
9428
9429 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
9430 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
9431 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
9432 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
9433
9434 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
9435 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
9436 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
9437 they never ignore case.
9438
9439 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
9440 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
9441 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
9442 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
9443 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
9444 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
9445 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
9446
9447 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
9448 the same format that was used in the file before.
9449
9450 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
9451 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
9452
9453 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
9454 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
9455 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
9456
9457 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
9458 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
9459 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
9460 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
9461 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
9462 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
9463 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
9464
9465 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
9466 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
9467 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
9468 format. You can now customize these variables.
9469
9470 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
9471 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
9472 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
9473 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
9474
9475 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
9476 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
9477 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
9478
9479 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
9480 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
9481 doesn't have any effect.
9482
9483 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
9484 not one per buffer.
9485
9486 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
9487 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
9488 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
9489
9490 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
9491 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
9492 `auto-show-mode' command.
9493
9494 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
9495 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
9496 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
9497 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
9498 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
9499
9500 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
9501 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
9502
9503 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
9504 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
9505 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
9506
9507 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
9508 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
9509 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
9510 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
9511
9512 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
9513
9514 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
9515 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
9516 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
9517 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
9518 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
9519
9520 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
9521 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
9522
9523 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
9524 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
9525 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
9526 `?' on other systems.
9527
9528 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
9529 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
9530 Unix.
9531
9532 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
9533 current codepage when it starts.
9534
9535 ** Mail changes
9536
9537 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
9538 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
9539 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
9540 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
9541 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
9542 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
9543 latin-1:
9544
9545 MIME-version: 1.0
9546 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
9547 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
9548
9549 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
9550 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
9551 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
9552 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
9553 buffer-file-coding-system.
9554
9555 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
9556 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
9557 mail.
9558
9559 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
9560 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
9561 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
9562 list of possible coding systems.
9563
9564 ** CC Mode changes
9565
9566 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
9567 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
9568 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
9569 docstring for details.
9570
9571 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
9572 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
9573 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
9574 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
9575 lineup functions use this feature currently.
9576
9577 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
9578 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
9579
9580 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
9581 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
9582
9583 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
9584 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
9585 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
9586 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
9587 anonymous classes.
9588
9589 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
9590 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
9591
9592 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
9593 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
9594 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
9595 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
9596
9597 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
9598 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
9599 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
9600 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
9601 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
9602
9603 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
9604
9605 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
9606
9607 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
9608 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
9609
9610 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
9611
9612 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
9613 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
9614 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
9615 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
9616 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
9617
9618 ** Gnus changes.
9619
9620 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
9621 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
9622 Gnus manual for the full story.
9623
9624 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
9625 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
9626 group, which is created automatically.
9627
9628 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
9629 values.
9630
9631 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
9632
9633 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
9634 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
9635
9636 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
9637 `C-u C-c C-c'.
9638
9639 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
9640
9641 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
9642 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
9643
9644 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
9645
9646 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
9647 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
9648
9649 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
9650 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
9651
9652 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
9653 control over simplification.
9654
9655 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
9656
9657 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
9658 limit.
9659
9660 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
9661
9662 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
9663
9664 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
9665 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
9666 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
9667
9668 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
9669 `a' forces normal posting method.
9670
9671 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
9672 -- `W d'.
9673
9674 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
9675 to a non-nil value.
9676
9677 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
9678 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
9679
9680 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
9681 has been added.
9682
9683 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
9684
9685 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
9686
9687 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
9688 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
9689
9690 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
9691 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
9692
9693 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
9694
9695 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
9696 been added.
9697
9698 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
9699 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
9700
9701 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
9702 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
9703
9704 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
9705
9706 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
9707
9708 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
9709
9710 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
9711
9712 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
9713 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
9714 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
9715
9716 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
9717 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
9718 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
9719 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
9720 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
9721
9722 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
9723 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
9724 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
9725 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
9726
9727 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
9728 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
9729 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
9730 mismatch.
9731
9732 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
9733
9734 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
9735 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
9736
9737 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
9738 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
9739 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
9740 removed from the label.
9741
9742 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
9743 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
9744
9745 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
9746 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
9747
9748 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
9749 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
9750 expressions.
9751
9752 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
9753
9754 ** New/deleted modes and packages
9755
9756 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
9757 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
9758
9759 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
9760 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
9761 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
9762
9763 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
9764 changes with a special face.
9765
9766 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
9767 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
9768 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
9769 \f
9770 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
9771
9772 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
9773 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
9774 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
9775 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
9776 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
9777
9778 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
9779 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
9780 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
9781
9782 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
9783 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
9784 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
9785 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
9786 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
9787 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
9788 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
9789 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
9790 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
9791
9792 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
9793 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
9794 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
9795 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
9796 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
9797 program.
9798
9799 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
9800 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
9801 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
9802 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
9803 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
9804 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
9805
9806 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
9807 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
9808 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
9809 was not documented clearly before.
9810
9811 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
9812 This includes Tetris and Snake.
9813 \f
9814 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
9815
9816 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
9817 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
9818 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
9819 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
9820
9821 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
9822 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
9823 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
9824
9825 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
9826
9827 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
9828 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
9829
9830 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
9831 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
9832 integers.
9833
9834 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
9835 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
9836 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
9837 file names and attributes are returned.
9838
9839 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
9840 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
9841 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
9842 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
9843 returns the result.
9844
9845 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
9846 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
9847
9848 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
9849
9850 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
9851 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
9852 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
9853 optionally.
9854
9855 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
9856 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
9857
9858 **
9859 The new function process-running-child-p
9860 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
9861 terminal to its own child process.
9862
9863 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
9864 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
9865 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
9866 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
9867
9868 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
9869 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
9870
9871 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
9872 :included is an alias for :visible.
9873
9874 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
9875 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
9876 to move or copy menu entries.
9877
9878 ** Multibyte editing changes
9879
9880 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
9881 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
9882 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
9883 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
9884 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
9885 (setq char (sref str idx)
9886 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
9887 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
9888
9889 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
9890 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
9891 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
9892
9893 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
9894 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
9895 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
9896
9897 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
9898
9899 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
9900 across the boundary.
9901
9902 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
9903 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
9904 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
9905 contains 8-bit characters.
9906 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
9907 contains invalid characters.
9908
9909 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
9910 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
9911 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
9912 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
9913 way.
9914
9915 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
9916 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
9917 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
9918 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
9919
9920 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
9921 compose Thai characters in a string.
9922
9923 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
9924 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
9925 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
9926 menus should always use the third argument.
9927
9928 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
9929 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
9930 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
9931 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
9932
9933 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
9934 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
9935 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
9936 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
9937
9938 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
9939 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
9940 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
9941 echo area contents.
9942
9943 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
9944
9945 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
9946 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
9947 requested feature cannot be loaded.
9948
9949 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
9950 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
9951 means to clear out that attribute.
9952
9953 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
9954 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
9955
9956 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
9957 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
9958 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
9959 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
9960
9961 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
9962 the gap of the current buffer.
9963
9964 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
9965 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
9966 current buffer.
9967
9968 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
9969 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
9970 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
9971 it back in after any modifications have been made.
9972 \f
9973 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
9974
9975 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
9976 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
9977 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
9978 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
9979 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
9980
9981 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
9982 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
9983 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
9984 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
9985 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
9986
9987 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
9988 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
9989 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
9990
9991 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
9992 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
9993 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
9994 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
9995 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
9996 results.
9997
9998 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
9999 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10000 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10001 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10002 \f
10003 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10004
10005 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10006 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10007 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10008 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10009
10010 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10011 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10012 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10013 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10014 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10015 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10016 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10017 region.
10018
10019 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10020 selective undo.
10021
10022 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10023 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10024 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10025 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10026 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10027
10028 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10029 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10030 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10031 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10032
10033 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10034 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10035 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10036 something that most users not do.
10037
10038 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10039 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10040 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10041 applications.
10042
10043 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10044 pasting operations.
10045
10046 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10047 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10048 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10049 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10050 `ps-printer-name'.
10051
10052 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10053 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10054 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10055 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10056 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10057 hits a new word.
10058
10059 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10060 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10061 to be confused by TeX commands.
10062
10063 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10064 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10065 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10066 of various alternative replacements and actions.
10067
10068 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10069 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10070 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10071 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10072 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10073
10074 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
10075 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
10076
10077 ** Changes in input method usage.
10078
10079 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
10080 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
10081 respectively.
10082
10083 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
10084
10085 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
10086 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
10087
10088 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
10089 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
10090
10091 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
10092
10093 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
10094
10095 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
10096 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
10097
10098 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
10099 given in the following case:
10100 o When you are using a complex input method.
10101 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
10102
10103 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
10104 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
10105 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
10106 setting it to t is helpful.
10107
10108 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
10109
10110 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
10111 keys:
10112 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
10113 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
10114 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
10115 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
10116 environment.
10117
10118 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
10119 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
10120 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
10121 get
10122
10123 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
10124
10125 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
10126
10127 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
10128 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
10129
10130 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
10131 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
10132 its owner and group.
10133
10134 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
10135 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
10136
10137 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
10138 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
10139
10140 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
10141 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
10142 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
10143 by the left edge of the rectangle.
10144
10145 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
10146 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
10147 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
10148 for writing keyboard macros.
10149
10150 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
10151 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
10152 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
10153 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
10154 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
10155 info.
10156
10157 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
10158
10159 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
10160 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
10161 contents only.
10162
10163 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
10164 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
10165 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
10166 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
10167
10168 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
10169 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
10170 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
10171
10172 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
10173 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
10174 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
10175 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
10176
10177 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
10178 failure if the command produces no output.
10179
10180 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
10181 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
10182 the mouse.
10183
10184 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
10185 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
10186 function and variable names.
10187
10188 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
10189 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
10190 file-coding-system-alist.
10191
10192 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
10193 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
10194 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
10195 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
10196 according to the current fontset.
10197
10198 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
10199
10200 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
10201 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
10202 nonascii-insert-offset.
10203
10204 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
10205 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
10206 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
10207 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
10208
10209 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
10210 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
10211
10212 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
10213 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
10214
10215 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
10216 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
10217 command keys.
10218
10219 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
10220 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
10221
10222 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
10223 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
10224 all variables that have documentation.
10225
10226 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
10227 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
10228 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
10229 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
10230 it should show; the default is 20.
10231
10232 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
10233 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
10234 of your input.
10235
10236 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
10237 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
10238 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
10239 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
10240 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
10241 Newly added options are included as well.
10242
10243 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
10244 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
10245 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
10246
10247 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
10248 Customize menu.
10249
10250 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
10251 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
10252
10253 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
10254 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
10255 invoked.
10256
10257 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
10258 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
10259 The default is 1.
10260
10261 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
10262 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
10263 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
10264 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
10265 sensibly.
10266
10267 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
10268
10269 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
10270 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
10271 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
10272
10273 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
10274 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
10275 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
10276 every night.
10277
10278 ** Desktop changes
10279
10280 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
10281 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
10282
10283 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
10284 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
10285
10286 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
10287 read and post multi-lingual articles.
10288
10289 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
10290 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
10291 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
10292 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
10293 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
10294 made invisible again.
10295
10296 ** Mail reading and sending changes
10297
10298 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
10299 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
10300 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
10301 toggle.
10302
10303 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
10304 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
10305 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
10306 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
10307 rmail-default-body-file.
10308
10309 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
10310 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
10311 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
10312
10313 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
10314 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
10315 is evaluated to insert the signature.
10316
10317 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
10318 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
10319 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
10320 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
10321 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
10322 especially interested in trying feedmail.
10323
10324 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
10325 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
10326 provided by feedmail are:
10327
10328 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
10329 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
10330 there is also a queue for draft messages
10331
10332 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
10333 be prompted for confirmation
10334
10335 **** does smart filling of address headers
10336
10337 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
10338 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
10339 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
10340
10341 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
10342 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
10343 /usr/lib/sendmail, and elisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
10344 function for something else (10-20 lines of elisp)
10345
10346 ** Dired changes
10347
10348 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
10349 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
10350
10351 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
10352 run Dired on the directory name at point.
10353
10354 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
10355 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
10356 for a specified regexp.
10357
10358 ** VC Changes
10359
10360 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
10361 conveniently.
10362
10363 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
10364 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
10365 Dired.
10366
10367 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
10368 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
10369 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
10370 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
10371
10372 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
10373 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
10374 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
10375 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
10376 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
10377
10378 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
10379 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
10380 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
10381 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
10382 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
10383
10384 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
10385 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
10386 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
10387 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
10388
10389 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
10390 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
10391 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
10392
10393 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
10394 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
10395 session to resolve them.
10396
10397 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
10398 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
10399 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
10400 uses as well).
10401
10402 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
10403 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
10404 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
10405 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
10406 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
10407 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
10408 using ediff.
10409
10410 ** Changes in Font Lock
10411
10412 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
10413 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
10414 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
10415 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
10416 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
10417
10418 ** Frame name display changes
10419
10420 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
10421 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
10422 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
10423 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
10424
10425 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
10426 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
10427 menu.
10428
10429 ** Comint (subshell) changes
10430
10431 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
10432 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
10433 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
10434
10435 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
10436
10437 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
10438 that is, the line after the last line you got.
10439 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
10440
10441 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
10442 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
10443 the following line.
10444
10445 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
10446 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
10447 previously sent input.
10448
10449 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
10450 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
10451 as the search string.
10452
10453 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
10454 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
10455
10456 ** C mode changes
10457
10458 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
10459 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
10460 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
10461 definition.
10462
10463 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
10464 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
10465 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
10466 style is still the default however.
10467
10468 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
10469
10470 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
10471 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
10472 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
10473
10474 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
10475 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
10476
10477 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
10478 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
10479
10480 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
10481 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
10482
10483 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
10484 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
10485
10486 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
10487 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
10488 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
10489 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
10490
10491 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
10492
10493 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
10494 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
10495 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
10496
10497 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
10498 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
10499 expanding dynamically.
10500
10501 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
10502 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
10503
10504 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
10505 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
10506 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
10507 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
10508
10509 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
10510
10511 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
10512
10513 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
10514 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
10515 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
10516 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
10517 against the first word in the title.
10518
10519 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
10520 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
10521 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
10522 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
10523 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
10524 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
10525
10526 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
10527 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
10528 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
10529 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
10530
10531 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
10532
10533 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
10534 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
10535 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
10536 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
10537 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
10538 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
10539
10540 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
10541 Editing group once the package is loaded.
10542
10543 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
10544 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
10545 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
10546
10547 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
10548 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
10549
10550 ** Ispell changes.
10551
10552 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
10553 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
10554 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
10555
10556 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
10557 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
10558 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
10559 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
10560 include:
10561
10562 o URLs are automatically skipped
10563 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
10564
10565 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
10566
10567 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10568
10569 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
10570 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
10571 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
10572 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
10573
10574 *** New recursive parser.
10575
10576 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
10577 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
10578 recursive parser scans the individual files.
10579
10580 *** Parsing only part of a document.
10581
10582 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
10583 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
10584 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
10585
10586 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
10587
10588 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
10589
10590 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
10591
10592 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
10593
10594 *** Using multiple selection buffers
10595
10596 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
10597 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
10598
10599 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
10600
10601 *** References to external documents.
10602
10603 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
10604 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
10605 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
10606 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
10607 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
10608 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
10609 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
10610
10611 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
10612
10613 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
10614 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
10615
10616 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
10617 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
10618
10619 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
10620
10621 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
10622 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
10623
10624 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
10625
10626 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
10627 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
10628 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
10629 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
10630 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
10631 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
10632 more.
10633
10634 *** Support for the varioref package
10635
10636 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
10637
10638 *** New hooks
10639
10640 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
10641 and citations are created. These hooks are
10642 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
10643 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
10644
10645 *** Citations outside LaTeX
10646
10647 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
10648 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
10649
10650 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
10651
10652 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
10653 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
10654 fontified, use
10655
10656 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
10657
10658 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
10659 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
10660 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
10661 directories that contain the same file name.
10662
10663 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
10664 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
10665 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
10666 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
10667 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
10668 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
10669 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
10670 directory.
10671
10672 ** New modes and packages
10673
10674 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
10675 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
10676 it, but some do not.
10677
10678 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
10679 code.
10680
10681 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
10682 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
10683 around in a buffer.
10684
10685 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
10686
10687 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
10688 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
10689 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
10690 established system of notation similar to Chess.
10691
10692 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
10693 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
10694 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
10695
10696 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
10697 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
10698 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
10699 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
10700 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
10701 the like.
10702
10703 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
10704 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
10705
10706 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
10707 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
10708 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
10709 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
10710
10711 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
10712
10713 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
10714 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
10715 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
10716 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
10717 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
10718 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
10719 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
10720 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
10721 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
10722 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
10723 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
10724
10725 Platform-specific modes:
10726
10727 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
10728 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
10729 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
10730 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
10731 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
10732 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
10733 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
10734 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
10735 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
10736 \f
10737 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10738
10739 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
10740 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
10741 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
10742 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
10743
10744 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
10745 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
10746 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
10747
10748 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
10749 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
10750 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
10751 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
10752
10753 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
10754 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
10755 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
10756 environment.
10757
10758 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
10759 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
10760 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
10761 current input method for reading this one event.
10762
10763 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
10764 now control whether to output certain characters as
10765 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
10766 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
10767 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
10768 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
10769 \f
10770 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10771
10772 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
10773 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
10774
10775 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
10776 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
10777 always increases point by 1.
10778
10779 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
10780 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
10781
10782 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
10783
10784 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
10785 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
10786 default value changed. For example,
10787
10788 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
10789 :type 'integer
10790 :group 'foo
10791 :version "20.3")
10792
10793 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
10794 :version "20.3")
10795
10796 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
10797 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
10798 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
10799 `:version' in the top level group.
10800
10801 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
10802
10803 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
10804 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
10805
10806 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
10807 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
10808 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
10809 to themselves.
10810
10811 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
10812 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
10813 values whatever.
10814
10815 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
10816 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
10817 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
10818
10819 ** Frame-local variables.
10820
10821 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
10822 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
10823 local bindings for that variable.
10824
10825 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
10826 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
10827 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
10828 parameter name.
10829
10830 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
10831 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
10832 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
10833 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
10834
10835 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
10836 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
10837 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
10838 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
10839
10840 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
10841 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
10842 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
10843 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
10844 See the documentation in sregex.el.
10845
10846 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
10847 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
10848 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
10849 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
10850
10851 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
10852 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
10853
10854 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
10855 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
10856 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
10857
10858 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
10859 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
10860 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
10861 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
10862
10863 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
10864 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
10865 empty input.
10866
10867 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
10868 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
10869 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
10870 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
10871 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
10872
10873 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
10874 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
10875 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
10876 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
10877
10878 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
10879 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
10880 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
10881 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
10882 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
10883
10884 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
10885 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
10886 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
10887 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
10888
10889 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
10890 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
10891 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
10892
10893 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
10894 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
10895 was directed to display this buffer.
10896
10897 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
10898 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
10899 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
10900 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
10901 set-window-configuration.
10902
10903 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
10904 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
10905 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
10906 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
10907
10908 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
10909 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
10910 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
10911
10912 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
10913 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
10914 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
10915
10916 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
10917 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
10918
10919 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
10920 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
10921
10922 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
10923 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
10924 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
10925
10926 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
10927 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
10928 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
10929 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
10930
10931 ** Menu changes
10932
10933 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
10934 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
10935 better supported.
10936
10937 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
10938 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
10939 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
10940 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
10941 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
10942
10943 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
10944
10945 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
10946 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
10947 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
10948 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
10949
10950 The format is:
10951 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
10952 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
10953 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
10954 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
10955 The supported properties include
10956
10957 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
10958 item is enabled.
10959 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
10960 item should appear in the menu.
10961 :filter FILTER-FN
10962 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
10963 which will be REAL-BINDING.
10964 It should return a binding to use instead.
10965 :keys DESCRIPTION
10966 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
10967 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
10968 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
10969 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
10970 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
10971 keyboard binding.
10972 :key-sequence nil
10973 This means that the command normally has no
10974 keyboard equivalent.
10975 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
10976 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
10977 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
10978 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
10979 value says whether this button is currently selected.
10980
10981 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
10982 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
10983
10984 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
10985
10986 ** New event types
10987
10988 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
10989 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
10990 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
10991 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
10992
10993 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
10994
10995 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
10996 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
10997 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
10998 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
10999 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11000 forward, away from the user.
11001
11002 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11003
11004 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11005 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11006 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11007 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11008 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11009
11010 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11011
11012 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11013 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11014 that were dragged and dropped.
11015
11016 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11017
11018 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11019
11020 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11021 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11022 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11023
11024 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11025 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11026 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11027
11028 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11029 in Emacs 19 and before.
11030
11031 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11032 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11033
11034 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11035 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11036 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11037 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11038
11039 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11040 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11041 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11042 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11043 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11044
11045 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11046 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11047 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11048 consistent with the new representation.
11049
11050 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11051 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11052 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11053 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11054
11055 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11056 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11057 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11058
11059 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11060 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11061 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11062
11063 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11064 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11065 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11066
11067 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11068 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11069
11070 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11071 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11072
11073 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11074 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
11075 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
11076 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
11077
11078 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
11079 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
11080
11081 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
11082 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
11083 buffer or string being searched.
11084
11085 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
11086 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
11087 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
11088 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
11089 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
11090 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
11091 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
11092
11093 *** Structure of coding system changed.
11094
11095 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
11096 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
11097 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
11098 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
11099 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
11100 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
11101 define-coding-system-alias.
11102
11103 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
11104 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
11105 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
11106 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
11107 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
11108 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
11109 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
11110 `iso-8859-1'.
11111
11112 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
11113 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
11114 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
11115 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
11116
11117 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
11118 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
11119 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
11120 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
11121
11122 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
11123 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
11124 This function requires a user interaction.
11125
11126 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
11127 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
11128 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
11129 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
11130 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
11131 select-safe-coding-system.
11132
11133 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
11134 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
11135 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
11136 was done.
11137
11138 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
11139 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
11140 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
11141
11142 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
11143 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
11144 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
11145 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
11146
11147 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
11148 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
11149 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
11150 converted.
11151
11152 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
11153 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
11154
11155 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
11156 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
11157 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
11158 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
11159 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
11160 range of characters.
11161
11162 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
11163 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
11164
11165 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
11166 in the current buffer at position POS.
11167
11168 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
11169 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
11170 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
11171 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
11172 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
11173 binding input-method-function to nil.
11174
11175 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
11176 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
11177 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
11178 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
11179 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
11180
11181 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
11182 subsequent events of a key sequence.
11183
11184 *** You can customize any language environment by using
11185 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
11186
11187 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
11188 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
11189 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
11190 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
11191 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
11192 \f
11193 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
11194
11195 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
11196 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
11197 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
11198 tree structure.
11199
11200 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
11201 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
11202
11203 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
11204 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
11205 in your .emacs file.)
11206
11207 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
11208 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
11209
11210 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
11211 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
11212
11213 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
11214 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
11215 kills the region.
11216
11217 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
11218 delete the character before point, as usual.
11219
11220 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
11221 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
11222 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
11223
11224 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
11225 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
11226 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
11227 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
11228 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
11229 past.)
11230
11231 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
11232 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
11233 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
11234 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
11235 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
11236
11237 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
11238 and is an alias for it.
11239
11240 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
11241 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
11242
11243 ** Scrolling changes
11244
11245 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
11246 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
11247
11248 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
11249 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
11250 where it started.
11251
11252 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
11253 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
11254 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
11255 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
11256
11257 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
11258 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
11259 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
11260 recenters the window.
11261
11262 ** International character set support (MULE)
11263
11264 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
11265 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
11266 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
11267 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
11268 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
11269 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
11270
11271 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
11272 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
11273 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
11274 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
11275 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
11276
11277 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
11278 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
11279 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
11280 language, to make it possible to type them.
11281
11282 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
11283 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
11284
11285 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
11286 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
11287
11288 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
11289
11290 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
11291
11292 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
11293 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
11294 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
11295 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
11296 characters for their work until they want to change.
11297
11298 *** Input methods
11299
11300 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
11301 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
11302 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
11303 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
11304 support several input methods.
11305
11306 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
11307 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
11308 work.
11309
11310 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
11311 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
11312 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
11313 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
11314 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
11315 letter.
11316
11317 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
11318 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
11319 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
11320 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
11321 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
11322
11323 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
11324 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
11325 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
11326 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
11327
11328 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
11329 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
11330 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
11331 the first guess is wrong.
11332
11333 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
11334 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
11335
11336 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
11337 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
11338 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
11339 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
11340
11341 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
11342 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
11343 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
11344 translate automatically to and from either one.
11345
11346 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
11347
11348 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
11349 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
11350 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
11351 what you want.
11352
11353 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
11354 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
11355 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
11356 multibyte characters in that buffer.
11357
11358 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
11359 character conversion as well.
11360
11361 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
11362
11363 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
11364 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
11365 requires using many fonts.
11366
11367 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
11368 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
11369
11370 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
11371 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
11372 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
11373 you would use a font.
11374
11375 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
11376 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
11377 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
11378
11379 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
11380 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
11381 characters).
11382
11383 *** Defining fontsets.
11384
11385 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
11386 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
11387 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
11388
11389 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
11390 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
11391 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
11392 standard fontset are created automatically.
11393
11394 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
11395 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
11396 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
11397 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
11398 name is `fontset-startup'.
11399
11400 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
11401 The resource value should have this form:
11402 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
11403 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
11404 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
11405 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
11406 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
11407 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
11408 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
11409 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
11410 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
11411
11412 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
11413 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
11414 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
11415
11416 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
11417 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
11418 following resource,
11419 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
11420 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
11421 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
11422 Here is the substitution rule:
11423 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
11424 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
11425 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
11426 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
11427 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
11428
11429 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
11430 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
11431 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
11432
11433 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
11434 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
11435 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
11436 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
11437 fontsets.
11438
11439 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
11440 defaults for a particular choice of language.
11441
11442 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
11443 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
11444 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
11445 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
11446 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
11447 system for new files that you create.
11448
11449 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
11450 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
11451 whole Emacs session.
11452
11453 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
11454 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
11455 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
11456
11457 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
11458 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
11459 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
11460 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
11461 coding systems that Emacs supports.
11462
11463 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
11464 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
11465 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
11466 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
11467 is used for *the immediately following command*.
11468
11469 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
11470 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
11471
11472 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
11473 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
11474
11475 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
11476 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
11477
11478 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
11479 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
11480 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
11481 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
11482 of the file.
11483
11484 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
11485 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
11486 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
11487 translated into that character code.
11488
11489 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
11490 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
11491
11492 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
11493
11494 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
11495 the coding system for keyboard input.
11496
11497 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
11498 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
11499 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
11500
11501 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
11502
11503 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
11504 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
11505 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
11506 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
11507 designed to work with terminals.
11508
11509 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
11510 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
11511 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
11512 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
11513 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
11514 in the corresponding buffer.
11515
11516 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
11517
11518 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
11519 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
11520 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
11521
11522 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
11523 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
11524 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
11525 want to use.
11526
11527 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
11528 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
11529
11530 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
11531 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
11532 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
11533 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
11534
11535 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
11536 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
11537 related information.
11538
11539 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
11540 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
11541 scripts.
11542
11543 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
11544 information about the support for a particular language.
11545 You specify the language as an argument.
11546
11547 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
11548 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
11549 first dash.
11550
11551 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
11552 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
11553 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
11554 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
11555
11556 A alternativnyj (Russian)
11557 B big5 (Chinese)
11558 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
11559 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
11560 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
11561 E euc-japan (Japanese)
11562 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11563 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
11564 K euc-korea (Korean)
11565 R koi8 (Russian)
11566 Q tibetan
11567 S shift_jis (Japanese)
11568 T lao
11569 T tis620 (Thai)
11570 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
11571 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11572 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
11573 v viqr (Vietnamese)
11574 z hz (Chinese)
11575
11576 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
11577 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
11578 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
11579 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
11580
11581 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
11582 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
11583
11584 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
11585 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
11586 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
11587 Rmail files themselves.
11588
11589 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
11590 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
11591
11592 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
11593 for sending mail:
11594
11595 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
11596 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
11597 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
11598 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
11599 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
11600
11601 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
11602 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
11603 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
11604 translations.
11605
11606 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
11607 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
11608 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
11609 without any conversion.
11610
11611 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
11612 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
11613 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
11614 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
11615
11616 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
11617 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
11618
11619 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
11620 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
11621
11622 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
11623 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
11624
11625 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
11626 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
11627 in the buffer before point.
11628
11629 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
11630 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
11631 you are using.
11632
11633 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
11634 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
11635
11636 ** File locking works with NFS now.
11637
11638 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
11639 in the same directory as FILENAME.
11640
11641 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
11642 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
11643 can become a bottleneck.
11644
11645 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
11646 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
11647 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
11648 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
11649 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
11650 so useful that the change is worth while.
11651
11652 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
11653 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
11654 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
11655 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
11656
11657 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
11658 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
11659 show-paren-mode.
11660
11661 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
11662 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
11663 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
11664
11665 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
11666 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
11667 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
11668
11669 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
11670 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
11671 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
11672
11673 ** Changes in View mode.
11674
11675 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
11676 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
11677
11678 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
11679 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
11680
11681 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
11682 previous state.
11683
11684 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
11685 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
11686
11687 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
11688 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
11689 not just the selected window.
11690
11691 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
11692 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
11693 turns View mode on or off.
11694
11695 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
11696 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
11697 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
11698
11699 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
11700 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
11701
11702 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
11703 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
11704 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
11705 which version to compare with.
11706
11707 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
11708 blocks if a match is inside the block.
11709
11710 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
11711 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
11712 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
11713 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
11714
11715 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
11716 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
11717 blocks, all of them or none.
11718
11719 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
11720 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
11721 confirmation first.
11722
11723 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
11724 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
11725 However, the mode will not be changed if
11726 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
11727 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
11728 not suitable for ordinary files, or
11729 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
11730
11731 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
11732
11733 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
11734 these commands do not change the major mode.
11735
11736 ** M-x occur changes.
11737
11738 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
11739 it performs a case-sensitive search.
11740
11741 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
11742 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
11743 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
11744
11745 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
11746 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
11747 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
11748 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
11749 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
11750
11751 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
11752 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
11753 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
11754 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
11755
11756 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
11757 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
11758 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
11759
11760 ** Outline mode changes.
11761
11762 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
11763
11764 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
11765
11766 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
11767 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
11768 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
11769 was already active.
11770
11771 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
11772 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
11773 get confused by it.
11774
11775 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
11776 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
11777
11778 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
11779
11780 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
11781 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
11782 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
11783 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
11784
11785 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
11786 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
11787 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
11788
11789 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
11790 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
11791 values.
11792
11793 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
11794 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
11795 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
11796 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
11797
11798 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
11799 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
11800 can be. The default value is 30.
11801
11802 ** Changes in Mail mode.
11803
11804 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
11805 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
11806 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
11807 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
11808 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
11809 behavior.
11810
11811 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
11812 compose-mail-other-frame.
11813
11814 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
11815 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
11816 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
11817 buffer that shows the original message.
11818
11819 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
11820 with separator lines around the contents.
11821
11822 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
11823 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
11824 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
11825 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
11826
11827 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
11828
11829 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
11830 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
11831 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
11832 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
11833
11834 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
11835 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
11836 /etc/passwd.
11837
11838 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
11839 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
11840 /etc/passwd.
11841
11842 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
11843 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
11844 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
11845 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
11846
11847 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
11848 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
11849 be taken to be magic.
11850
11851 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
11852 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
11853 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
11854
11855 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
11856 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
11857
11858 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
11859 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
11860
11861 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
11862
11863 new key dired.el binding old key
11864 ------- ---------------- -------
11865 * c dired-change-marks c
11866 * m dired-mark m
11867 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
11868 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
11869 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
11870 * u dired-unmark u
11871 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
11872 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
11873 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
11874 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
11875 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
11876 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
11877
11878 ** Rmail changes.
11879
11880 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
11881 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
11882 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
11883 each time you run it.
11884
11885 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
11886 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
11887
11888 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
11889 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
11890 means to move in the opposite direction.
11891
11892 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
11893 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
11894
11895 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
11896 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
11897 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
11898 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
11899 for output.
11900
11901 ** Gnus changes.
11902
11903 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
11904
11905 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
11906 Gnus.
11907
11908 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
11909 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
11910
11911 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
11912 article mode line.
11913
11914 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
11915
11916 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
11917
11918 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
11919
11920 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
11921 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
11922 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
11923
11924 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
11925
11926 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
11927
11928 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
11929 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
11930
11931 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
11932 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
11933 used to pick articles.
11934
11935 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
11936 another have been added.
11937
11938 `M-x gnus-change-server'
11939
11940 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
11941 generating lines in buffers.
11942
11943 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
11944 `C-M-_'.
11945
11946 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
11947
11948 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
11949
11950 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
11951
11952 *** Scores can be decayed.
11953
11954 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
11955
11956 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
11957 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
11958
11959 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
11960 the native server.
11961
11962 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
11963
11964 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
11965 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
11966
11967 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
11968
11969 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
11970 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
11971
11972 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
11973 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
11974
11975 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
11976 a group.
11977
11978 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
11979 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
11980
11981 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
11982
11983 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
11984
11985 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
11986
11987 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
11988
11989 Use the `Y c' command.
11990
11991 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
11992
11993 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
11994
11995 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
11996
11997 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
11998 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
11999
12000 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12001
12002 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12003
12004 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12005 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12006
12007 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12008
12009 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12010 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12011 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12012 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12013 this issue.)
12014
12015 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12016 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12017 particular news group. This can be done by:
12018
12019 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12020
12021 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12022 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12023 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12024 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12025 for reading and posting).
12026
12027 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12028 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12029 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12030 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12031 there.
12032
12033 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12034 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12035
12036 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12037 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12038 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12039 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12040 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12041
12042 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12043 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12044
12045 ** CC mode changes.
12046
12047 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12048 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12049 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12050 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12051 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12052 loaded.
12053
12054 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12055 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12056 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12057 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12058 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12059 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12060
12061 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12062 of the current buffer.
12063
12064 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12065 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12066 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12067
12068 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12069 style that the Python developers like.
12070
12071 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12072 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12073 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12074
12075 ** VC Changes [new]
12076
12077 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
12078 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
12079 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
12080
12081 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
12082 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
12083 developers.
12084
12085 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
12086 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
12087
12088 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
12089 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
12090 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
12091 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
12092
12093 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
12094 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
12095
12096 ** Calendar changes.
12097
12098 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
12099 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
12100 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
12101 following/previous years.
12102
12103 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
12104 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
12105 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
12106 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
12107 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
12108 supposed attribute of God.
12109
12110 ** ps-print changes
12111
12112 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
12113 layout.
12114
12115 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
12116
12117 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
12118 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
12119 printer system has this behavior, set variable
12120 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
12121
12122 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
12123 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
12124 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
12125
12126 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
12127 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
12128
12129 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
12130 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
12131 printing for your printer.
12132
12133 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
12134 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12135
12136 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
12137 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12138
12139 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
12140 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
12141 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
12142 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
12143 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
12144 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
12145 The default value is nil.
12146
12147 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
12148 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
12149
12150 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
12151 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
12152 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
12153 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
12154 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
12155 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
12156 color). The default is 0 ("black").
12157
12158 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
12159 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
12160
12161 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
12162 The default is 0 ("black").
12163
12164 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
12165 The default is 0 ("black").
12166
12167 border-width Specify the border width.
12168 The default is 0.4.
12169
12170 Any other property is ignored.
12171
12172 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
12173 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
12174 documentation).
12175
12176 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
12177 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
12178 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
12179 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
12180 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
12181 controlling headers.
12182
12183 *** Color management (subgroup)
12184
12185 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
12186 color.
12187
12188 *** Face Management (subgroup)
12189
12190 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
12191 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
12192 background should be used. Valid values are:
12193
12194 t always use face background color.
12195 nil never use face background color.
12196 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
12197
12198 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
12199
12200 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
12201 sheet of paper.
12202
12203 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
12204 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
12205
12206 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
12207 each page.
12208
12209 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
12210 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
12211 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
12212
12213 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
12214 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
12215 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
12216
12217 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
12218 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
12219 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
12220
12221 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
12222 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
12223 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
12224
12225 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
12226 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
12227 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
12228
12229 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
12230
12231 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
12232
12233 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
12234 RGB color.
12235
12236 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
12237 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
12238 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
12239
12240 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
12241 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12242 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12243 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12244 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12245 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
12246 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
12247 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
12248 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12249 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12250 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12251 10 + 10 +
12252 11 + 11 +
12253 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12254 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12255 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
12256 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
12257 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
12258 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12259 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12260 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12261 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
12262 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
12263 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
12264 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
12265 22 + 22 +
12266 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12267
12268 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
12269
12270
12271 *** Printer management (subgroup)
12272
12273 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
12274 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
12275 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
12276 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
12277 to "-P".
12278
12279 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
12280 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
12281 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
12282
12283 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
12284 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
12285 do so.
12286
12287 *** Page settings (subgroup)
12288
12289 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
12290 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
12291 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
12292 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
12293 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
12294 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
12295 `setpagedevice'.
12296
12297 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
12298 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
12299 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
12300
12301 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
12302 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
12303 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
12304 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
12305 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
12306 its TO, are ignored.
12307
12308 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
12309 pages. Valid values are:
12310
12311 nil print all pages.
12312
12313 `even-page' print only even pages.
12314
12315 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
12316
12317 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
12318 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12319 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
12320 print only the even sheet of paper.
12321
12322 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
12323 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12324 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
12325 only the odd sheet of paper.
12326
12327 Any other value is treated as nil.
12328
12329 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
12330 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
12331 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
12332
12333 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
12334
12335 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
12336 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
12337
12338 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
12339 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12340 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
12341 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12342 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12343 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12344 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12345
12346 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
12347 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12348 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
12349 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
12350 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
12351 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
12352 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
12353
12354 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
12355
12356 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
12357 messages should be sent.
12358
12359 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
12360 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
12361 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
12362
12363 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
12364
12365 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
12366 points for line numbers.
12367
12368 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
12369 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
12370
12371 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
12372 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
12373 to 2, the printing will look like:
12374
12375 1 one line
12376 one line
12377 3 one line
12378 one line
12379 5 one line
12380 one line
12381 ...
12382
12383 Valid values are:
12384
12385 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
12386 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
12387 is used.
12388
12389 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
12390 zebra stripe is to be printed.
12391
12392 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
12393
12394 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
12395 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
12396 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
12397 3, the output will look like:
12398
12399 one line
12400 one line
12401 3 one line
12402 one line
12403 one line
12404 6 one line
12405 one line
12406 one line
12407 9 one line
12408 one line
12409 ...
12410
12411 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
12412 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
12413
12414 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
12415 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12416 `ps-font-size').
12417
12418 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
12419 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12420 `ps-font-size').
12421
12422 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
12423
12424 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
12425 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
12426
12427 ** hideshow changes.
12428
12429 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
12430 C++, ; for lisp).
12431
12432 *** Support for java-mode added.
12433
12434 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
12435 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
12436
12437 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
12438 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
12439 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
12440
12441 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
12442 robust and a lot faster.
12443
12444 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
12445
12446 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
12447 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
12448 documentation for more details.
12449
12450 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
12451
12452 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
12453 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
12454 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
12455 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
12456 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
12457
12458 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
12459 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
12460 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
12461 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
12462
12463 ** Font Lock mode
12464
12465 *** Custom support
12466
12467 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
12468 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
12469 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
12470 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
12471 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
12472 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
12473
12474 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
12475
12476 *** Maximum decoration
12477
12478 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
12479 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
12480 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
12481 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
12482 to get the old behavior.
12483
12484 *** New support
12485
12486 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
12487
12488 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
12489 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
12490
12491 *** Configurable support
12492
12493 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
12494 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
12495 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
12496 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
12497 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
12498 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
12499 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
12500
12501 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
12502 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
12503 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
12504
12505 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
12506
12507 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
12508 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
12509 for any mode.
12510
12511 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
12512
12513 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
12514
12515 in your ~/.emacs.
12516
12517 *** New faces
12518
12519 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
12520 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
12521 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
12522 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
12523
12524 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
12525
12526 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
12527 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
12528 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
12529
12530 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
12531
12532 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
12533 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
12534 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
12535 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
12536 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
12537 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
12538 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
12539
12540 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
12541 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
12542 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
12543 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
12544 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
12545 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
12546
12547 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
12548
12549 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
12550 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
12551 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
12552 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
12553
12554 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
12555 settings.
12556
12557 ** Ada mode changes.
12558
12559 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
12560 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
12561 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
12562 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
12563 stubs.
12564
12565 *** There are two new commands:
12566 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
12567 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
12568
12569 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
12570 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
12571 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
12572
12573 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
12574 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
12575 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
12576
12577 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
12578 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
12579 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
12580 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
12581
12582 ** Scheme mode changes.
12583
12584 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
12585 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
12586 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
12587 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
12588 have any effect.
12589
12590 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
12591 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
12592 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
12593 variables as buffer-local variables.
12594
12595 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
12596 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
12597
12598 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
12599
12600 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
12601 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
12602 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
12603 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
12604
12605 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
12606 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
12607 buffer in Emacs.
12608
12609 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
12610 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
12611 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
12612 option takes precedence.
12613
12614 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
12615 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
12616 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
12617
12618 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
12619 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
12620 the current defun.
12621
12622 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
12623 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
12624
12625 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
12626 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
12627 necessary).
12628
12629 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
12630 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
12631 these register values no longer become completely useless.
12632 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
12633 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
12634 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
12635
12636 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
12637 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
12638 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
12639 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
12640
12641 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
12642 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
12643 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
12644 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
12645 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
12646
12647 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
12648 since it applies only to the current frame.
12649
12650 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
12651 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
12652 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
12653
12654 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
12655 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
12656 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
12657 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
12658 instead of just the file you are editing.
12659
12660 ** RefTeX mode
12661
12662 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
12663 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
12664 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
12665 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
12666 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
12667
12668 C-c ( reftex-label
12669 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
12670 knows which kind of label is needed.
12671
12672 C-c ) reftex-reference
12673 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
12674 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
12675
12676 C-c [ reftex-citation
12677 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
12678 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
12679
12680 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
12681 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
12682
12683 C-c = reftex-toc
12684 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
12685 can quickly jump to every section.
12686
12687 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
12688 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
12689 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
12690 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
12691 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
12692
12693 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
12694
12695 *** Info documentation is now available.
12696
12697 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
12698 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
12699
12700 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
12701 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
12702
12703 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
12704 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
12705
12706 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
12707 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
12708 appropriate functions.
12709
12710 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
12711 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
12712
12713 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
12714 been cleaned.
12715
12716 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
12717 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
12718
12719 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
12720 shall be delimited.
12721
12722 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
12723 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
12724 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
12725
12726 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
12727 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
12728 prefixed with `ALT'.
12729
12730 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
12731 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
12732 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
12733 documentation).
12734
12735 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
12736 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
12737 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
12738
12739 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
12740 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
12741
12742 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
12743 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
12744 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
12745
12746 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
12747
12748 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
12749
12750 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
12751 from alien sources.
12752
12753 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
12754 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
12755 crossref entries.
12756
12757 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
12758 region.
12759
12760 *** Added support for imenu.
12761
12762 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
12763 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
12764 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
12765 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
12766
12767 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
12768 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
12769
12770 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
12771
12772 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
12773
12774 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
12775 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
12776 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
12777 as an argument.
12778
12779 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
12780 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
12781
12782 ** browse-url changes
12783
12784 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
12785 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
12786 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
12787 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
12788 customization variables.
12789
12790 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
12791
12792 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
12793 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
12794 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
12795
12796 ** Changes in Ediff
12797
12798 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
12799 pops up the Info file for this command.
12800
12801 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
12802 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
12803 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
12804 directories).
12805
12806 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
12807 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
12808 files in the same directory.
12809
12810 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
12811 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
12812 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
12813
12814 ** Changes in Viper
12815
12816 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
12817 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
12818 instead of vip-.
12819 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
12820 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
12821 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
12822 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
12823 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
12824 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
12825 color when Viper is in insert state.
12826 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
12827 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
12828 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
12829
12830 ** Etags changes.
12831
12832 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
12833 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
12834 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
12835 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
12836 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
12837
12838 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
12839
12840 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
12841 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
12842
12843 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
12844 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
12845 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
12846
12847 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
12848 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
12849 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
12850 methods and protocols.
12851
12852 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
12853 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
12854 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
12855 paragraph name.
12856
12857 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
12858 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
12859 at least M times and as many as N times.
12860
12861 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
12862 in files has changed slightly.
12863
12864 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
12865 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
12866 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
12867 with old time-stamp-format values.
12868
12869 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
12870 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
12871 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
12872 reasons.
12873
12874 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
12875 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
12876 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
12877 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
12878 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
12879 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
12880
12881 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
12882 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
12883 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
12884
12885 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
12886 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
12887 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
12888 recommended now will continue to work then.
12889
12890 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
12891 details.
12892
12893 ** There are some additional major modes:
12894
12895 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
12896 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
12897 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
12898
12899 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
12900 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
12901 into Emacs.
12902
12903 ** New Lisp packages include:
12904
12905 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
12906
12907 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
12908 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
12909
12910 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
12911
12912 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
12913 in shell buffers.
12914
12915 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
12916 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
12917 and `elint-defun'.
12918
12919 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
12920 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
12921 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
12922 strings or comments.
12923
12924 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
12925 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
12926 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
12927 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
12928 at these points.
12929
12930 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
12931 can visit them by short forms of their names.
12932
12933 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
12934 Emacs Lisp function at point.
12935
12936 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
12937
12938 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
12939 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
12940
12941 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
12942
12943 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
12944
12945 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
12946
12947 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
12948 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
12949
12950 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
12951 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
12952 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
12953 original place after inserting the copy.
12954
12955 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
12956 on the buffer.
12957
12958 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
12959 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
12960 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
12961
12962 Enable mouse-drag with:
12963 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
12964 -or-
12965 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
12966
12967 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
12968 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
12969
12970 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
12971 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
12972
12973 *** ogonek
12974
12975 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
12976 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
12977 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
12978 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
12979 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
12980 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
12981 instance) and vice versa.
12982
12983 To use this package load it using
12984 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
12985 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
12986 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
12987 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
12988 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
12989 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
12990
12991 *** Interface to ph.
12992
12993 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
12994
12995 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
12996 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
12997 these servers.
12998
12999 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13000
13001 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13002 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13003 while the real cursor does not move.
13004
13005 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13006 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13007
13008 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13009 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13010
13011 ** movemail change
13012
13013 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13014 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13015 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13016 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13017
13018 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13019 \f
13020 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13021
13022 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13023
13024 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13025 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13026 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13027 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13028 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13029
13030 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13031 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13032 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13033 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13034 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13035 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13036 \f
13037 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13038
13039 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13040 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13041 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13042 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13043
13044 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13045 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13046
13047 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13048 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13049 "win".
13050
13051 ** Basic Lisp changes
13052
13053 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13054 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13055
13056 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13057 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13058 or by the user.
13059
13060 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13061
13062 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13063
13064 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13065 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13066
13067 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13068 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13069 its argument.
13070
13071 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13072
13073 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13074
13075 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
13076
13077 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
13078 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
13079 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
13080 `format' function.
13081
13082 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
13083 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
13084 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
13085
13086 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
13087 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
13088 adding one of these suffixes.
13089
13090 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
13091 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
13092 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
13093
13094 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
13095 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
13096
13097 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
13098
13099 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
13100 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
13101
13102 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
13103 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
13104
13105 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
13106
13107 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
13108 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
13109
13110 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
13111 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
13112 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
13113 works using `save-current-buffer'.
13114
13115 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
13116 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
13117 of the last form.
13118
13119 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
13120 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
13121 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
13122 as the last form.
13123
13124 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
13125 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
13126 matches.
13127
13128 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
13129
13130 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
13131 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
13132 Then it returns that string.
13133
13134 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
13135
13136 (with-output-to-string
13137 (princ "The buffer is ")
13138 (princ (buffer-name)))
13139
13140 returns "The buffer is foo".
13141
13142 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
13143 is non-nil.
13144
13145 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
13146 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
13147 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
13148
13149 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
13150 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
13151
13152 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
13153 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
13154 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
13155 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
13156 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
13157 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
13158
13159 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
13160 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
13161 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
13162 characters".
13163
13164 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
13165 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
13166 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
13167 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
13168 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
13169
13170 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
13171 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
13172 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
13173 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
13174
13175 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
13176 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
13177
13178 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
13179
13180 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
13181 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
13182 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
13183 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
13184 guaranteed.
13185
13186 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
13187 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
13188 character).
13189
13190 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
13191
13192 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
13193 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
13194 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
13195 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
13196 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
13197
13198 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
13199
13200 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
13201 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
13202 more than the number of characters.
13203
13204 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
13205 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
13206 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
13207 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
13208 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
13209 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
13210
13211 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
13212 and returns a string containing those characters.
13213
13214 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
13215 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
13216 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
13217 character, sref signals an error.
13218
13219 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
13220 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
13221 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13222
13223 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
13224 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
13225 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13226
13227 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
13228 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
13229 to a vector of the characters in it.
13230
13231 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
13232 of a string. You call it as follows:
13233
13234 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
13235
13236 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
13237 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
13238 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
13239 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
13240 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
13241
13242 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
13243 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13244
13245 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
13246 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13247
13248 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
13249 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
13250 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
13251 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
13252
13253 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
13254
13255 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
13256
13257 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
13258 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
13259 are not included in the resulting value.
13260
13261 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
13262 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
13263 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
13264 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
13265
13266 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
13267 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
13268 character extends across that column), then the padding character
13269 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
13270 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
13271 column START-COLUMN.
13272
13273 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
13274 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
13275 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
13276 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
13277 changed text, before the change.
13278
13279 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
13280 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
13281 one character set for each script, not for each language.
13282
13283 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
13284
13285 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
13286
13287 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
13288 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
13289
13290 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
13291 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
13292 which identify the character within that character set.
13293
13294 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
13295 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
13296 opposite of split-char.
13297
13298 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
13299 of all the characters between BEG and END.
13300
13301 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
13302 of all the characters in a string.
13303
13304 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
13305 and specifying coding systems.
13306
13307 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
13308 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
13309 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
13310 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
13311 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
13312 as what to do about code conversion.)
13313
13314 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
13315 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
13316
13317 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13318 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13319 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
13320
13321 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13322 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
13323 to match against a file name.
13324
13325 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13326 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13327 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13328 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13329 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13330 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13331
13332 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13333 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13334
13335 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
13336 the coding system to use for network sockets.
13337
13338 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13339 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
13340 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
13341 service names.
13342
13343 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13344 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13345 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13346 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13347 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13348 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13349
13350 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13351 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13352
13353 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13354 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13355 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
13356 start the subprocess.
13357
13358 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
13359 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
13360 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
13361 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
13362 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
13363
13364 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
13365 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
13366 subprocess.
13367
13368 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
13369 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
13370 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
13371 connection permanently or until overridden.
13372
13373 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
13374 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
13375 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
13376 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
13377 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
13378 system for one operation at a time.
13379
13380 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
13381 files, subprocesses or network connections.
13382
13383 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
13384 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
13385 The value is a cons cell,
13386 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
13387 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
13388 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
13389 input to the subprocess.
13390
13391 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
13392 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
13393
13394 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
13395 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
13396 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
13397
13398 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
13399 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
13400 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
13401 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
13402 customization.
13403
13404 Thus, instead of writing
13405
13406 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
13407 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
13408
13409 you would now write this:
13410
13411 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
13412 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
13413 :type 'boolean
13414 :group foo)
13415
13416 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
13417 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
13418 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
13419 for a description of them.
13420
13421 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
13422 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
13423
13424 (defgroup ispell nil
13425 "Spell checking using Ispell."
13426 :group 'processes)
13427
13428 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
13429 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
13430 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
13431 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
13432 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
13433
13434 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
13435 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
13436 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
13437 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
13438 first-level subgroups.
13439
13440 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
13441
13442 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
13443 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
13444
13445 ** easy-mmode
13446
13447 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
13448 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
13449 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
13450 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
13451 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
13452 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
13453
13454 ** Text property changes
13455
13456 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
13457 text property.
13458
13459 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
13460 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
13461 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
13462 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
13463 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
13464
13465 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
13466 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
13467 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
13468 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
13469
13470 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
13471 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
13472 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
13473
13474 ** Changes in invisibility features
13475
13476 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
13477 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
13478 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
13479 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
13480 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
13481 make the overlay visible.
13482
13483 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
13484 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
13485 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
13486 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
13487 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
13488 t when it should hide it.
13489
13490 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
13491
13492 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
13493 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
13494 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
13495 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
13496 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
13497 Here is an example of how to do this:
13498
13499 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
13500 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13501 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
13502 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13503
13504 ...
13505 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
13506
13507 ...
13508 ;; When done with the overlays:
13509 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13510 ;; Or respectively:
13511 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13512
13513 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
13514
13515 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
13516 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
13517 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
13518 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
13519
13520 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
13521 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
13522 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
13523
13524 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
13525 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
13526
13527 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
13528 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
13529
13530 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
13531 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
13532 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
13533
13534 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
13535 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
13536 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
13537 determine the syntax type of the character.
13538
13539 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
13540 of the current buffer.
13541
13542 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
13543 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
13544 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
13545
13546 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
13547 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
13548 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
13549 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
13550 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
13551
13552 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
13553 text property.
13554
13555 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
13556 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
13557 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
13558
13559 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
13560 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
13561 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
13562 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
13563 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
13564
13565 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
13566 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
13567 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
13568
13569 ** Changes in face features
13570
13571 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
13572 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
13573
13574 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
13575 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
13576
13577 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
13578 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
13579
13580 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
13581 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
13582
13583 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
13584 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
13585 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
13586 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
13587 overlay property).
13588
13589 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
13590 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
13591
13592 ** Changes in file-handling functions
13593
13594 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
13595 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
13596 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
13597 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
13598
13599 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
13600 begins with ~.
13601
13602 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
13603 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
13604
13605 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
13606 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
13607
13608 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
13609 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
13610
13611 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
13612 character code conversion as well as other things.
13613
13614 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
13615 (formerly it did not).
13616
13617 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
13618 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
13619
13620 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
13621 instead of constant strings.
13622
13623 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
13624 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
13625 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
13626
13627 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
13628 in the same way as before.
13629
13630 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
13631 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
13632 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
13633
13634 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
13635 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
13636 else, and returns nil.
13637
13638 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
13639 directory cannot be listed.
13640
13641 ** Changes in minibuffer input
13642
13643 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
13644 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
13645 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
13646 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
13647 ways:
13648
13649 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
13650 It is available through the history command M-n.
13651
13652 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
13653 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
13654 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
13655 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
13656 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
13657
13658 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
13659 argument in this way.
13660
13661 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
13662 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
13663 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
13664
13665 ** Echo area features
13666
13667 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
13668 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
13669 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
13670 after the echo area is cleared.
13671
13672 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
13673 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
13674
13675 ** Keyboard input features
13676
13677 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
13678 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
13679
13680 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
13681 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
13682 by keyboard macros.
13683
13684 ** Frame-related changes
13685
13686 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
13687 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
13688 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
13689
13690 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
13691 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
13692 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
13693
13694 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
13695 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
13696 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
13697 in the selected frame.
13698
13699 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
13700 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
13701 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
13702
13703 ** X Windows features
13704
13705 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
13706 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
13707 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
13708
13709 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
13710 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
13711
13712 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
13713 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
13714 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
13715
13716 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
13717 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
13718
13719 ** Subprocess features
13720
13721 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
13722 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
13723 automatically.
13724
13725 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
13726 and returns the output from the command as a string.
13727
13728 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
13729 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
13730
13731 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
13732 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
13733
13734 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
13735 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
13736 goes after the other menu items.
13737
13738 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
13739 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
13740 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
13741 are in use.
13742
13743 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
13744 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
13745
13746 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
13747 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
13748 form.
13749
13750 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
13751 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
13752 but its hook is still run.
13753
13754 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
13755 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
13756
13757 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
13758 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
13759 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
13760
13761 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
13762 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
13763 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
13764 warned.
13765
13766 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
13767 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
13768
13769 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
13770 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
13771 functions like display-time.
13772
13773 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
13774 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
13775
13776 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
13777 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
13778 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
13779
13780 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
13781 if there is an error in compilation.
13782
13783 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
13784 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
13785 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
13786 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
13787
13788 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
13789 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
13790 the *scratch* buffer.
13791
13792 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
13793 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
13794 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
13795 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
13796
13797 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
13798 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
13799 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
13800
13801 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
13802 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
13803 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
13804 and compose-mail-other-frame.
13805
13806 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
13807 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
13808 full name of the specified user will be returned.
13809
13810 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
13811 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
13812 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
13813 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
13814 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
13815 files at all.
13816
13817 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
13818 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
13819 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
13820 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
13821
13822 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
13823 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
13824 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
13825 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
13826
13827 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
13828
13829 ** imenu.el changes.
13830
13831 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
13832 item from menu created by imenu.
13833
13834 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
13835 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
13836 select one of those items.
13837 \f
13838 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
13839
13840 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
13841 Copyright information:
13842
13843 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13844
13845 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
13846 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
13847 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
13848 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
13849
13850 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
13851 of this document, or of portions of it,
13852 under the above conditions, provided also that they
13853 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
13854 \f
13855 Local variables:
13856 mode: outline
13857 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
13858 end:
13859
13860 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793